1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6 *
7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <linux/android_kabi.h>
27 #include <net/regulatory.h>
28
29 /**
30 * DOC: Introduction
31 *
32 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
33 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
34 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
35 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
36 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
37 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
38 *
39 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
40 * use restrictions.
41 */
42
43
44 /**
45 * DOC: Device registration
46 *
47 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
48 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
49 * described below.
50 *
51 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
52 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
53 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
54 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
55 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
56 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
57 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
58 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
59 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
60 *
61 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
62 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
63 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
64 */
65
66 struct wiphy;
67
68 /*
69 * wireless hardware capability structures
70 */
71
72 /**
73 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
74 *
75 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
76 *
77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
78 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
79 * sending probe requests or beaconing.
80 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
82 * is not permitted.
83 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
84 * is not permitted.
85 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
87 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
88 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
89 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
90 * restrictions.
91 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
92 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
93 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
94 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
95 * restrictions.
96 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
99 * on this channel.
100 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
101 * on this channel.
102 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
104 * on this channel.
105 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
106 * on this channel.
107 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
108 * on this channel.
109 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
110 * on this channel.
111 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
112 * on this channel.
113 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
114 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
115 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
116 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
117 * restrictions.
118 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
119 */
120 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
121 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0,
122 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1,
123 /* hole at 1<<2 */
124 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3,
125 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4,
126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5,
127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6,
128 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7,
129 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8,
130 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9,
131 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10,
132 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11,
133 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12,
134 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13,
135 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14,
136 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15,
137 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16,
138 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17,
139 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18,
140 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = 1<<19,
141 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = 1<<20,
142 };
143
144 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
145 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
146
147 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000
148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000)
149
150 /**
151 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
152 *
153 * This structure describes a single channel for use
154 * with cfg80211.
155 *
156 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
157 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
158 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
159 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
160 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
161 * code to support devices with additional restrictions
162 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
163 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
164 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
165 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
166 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
167 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
168 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
169 * @orig_mag: internal use
170 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
171 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
172 * on this channel.
173 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
174 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
175 */
176 struct ieee80211_channel {
177 enum nl80211_band band;
178 u32 center_freq;
179 u16 freq_offset;
180 u16 hw_value;
181 u32 flags;
182 int max_antenna_gain;
183 int max_power;
184 int max_reg_power;
185 bool beacon_found;
186 u32 orig_flags;
187 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
188 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
189 unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
190 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
191 };
192
193 /**
194 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
195 *
196 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
197 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
198 * different bands/PHY modes.
199 *
200 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
201 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
202 * with CCK rates.
203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
204 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
205 * core code when registering the wiphy.
206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
207 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
208 * core code when registering the wiphy.
209 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
210 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
211 * core code when registering the wiphy.
212 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
213 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
214 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
215 */
216 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
217 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0,
218 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1,
219 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2,
220 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3,
221 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4,
222 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5,
223 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6,
224 };
225
226 /**
227 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
228 *
229 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
230 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
231 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
232 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
233 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
234 */
235 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
236 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
237 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
238 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
239 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
240 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
245 *
246 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
247 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
248 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
249 */
250 enum ieee80211_privacy {
251 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
252 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
253 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
254 };
255
256 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \
257 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
258
259 /**
260 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
261 *
262 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
263 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
264 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
265 * passed around.
266 *
267 * @flags: rate-specific flags
268 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
269 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
270 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
271 * short preamble is used
272 */
273 struct ieee80211_rate {
274 u32 flags;
275 u16 bitrate;
276 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
277 };
278
279 /**
280 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
281 *
282 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
283 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
284 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
285 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
286 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
287 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
288 * members of the SRG
289 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
290 * used by members of the SRG
291 */
292 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
293 bool enable;
294 u8 sr_ctrl;
295 u8 non_srg_max_offset;
296 u8 min_offset;
297 u8 max_offset;
298 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
299 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
300 };
301
302 /**
303 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
304 *
305 * @color: the current color.
306 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
307 * @partial: define the AID equation.
308 */
309 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
310 u8 color;
311 bool enabled;
312 bool partial;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
317 *
318 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
319 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
320 *
321 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
322 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
323 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
324 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
325 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
326 */
327 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
328 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
329 bool ht_supported;
330 u8 ampdu_factor;
331 u8 ampdu_density;
332 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
333 };
334
335 /**
336 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
337 *
338 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
339 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
340 *
341 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
342 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
343 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
344 */
345 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
346 bool vht_supported;
347 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
348 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
349 };
350
351 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25
352
353 /**
354 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
355 *
356 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
357 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
358 *
359 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
360 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
361 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
362 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
363 */
364 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
365 bool has_he;
366 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
367 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
368 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
369 };
370
371 /**
372 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
373 *
374 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
375 * and NSS Set field"
376 *
377 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
378 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
379 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
380 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
381 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
382 */
383 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
384 union {
385 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
386 struct {
387 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
388 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
389 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
390 } __packed bw;
391 } __packed;
392 } __packed;
393
394 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32
395
396 /**
397 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
398 *
399 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
400 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
401 *
402 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
403 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
404 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
405 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
406 */
407 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
408 bool has_eht;
409 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
410 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
411 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
412 };
413
414 /**
415 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
416 *
417 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
418 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the
419 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
420 *
421 * @types_mask: interface types mask
422 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
423 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
424 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
425 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
426 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
427 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
428 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
429 */
430 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
431 u16 types_mask;
432 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
433 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
434 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
435 struct {
436 const u8 *data;
437 unsigned int len;
438 } vendor_elems;
439 };
440
441 /**
442 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
443 *
444 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
445 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
446 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
447 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
448 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
449 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
450 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
451 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
452 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
453 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
454 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
455 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
456 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
457 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
458 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
459 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
460 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
461 */
462 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
463 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4,
464 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5,
465 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6,
466 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7,
467 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8,
468 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9,
469 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10,
470 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11,
471 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12,
472 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13,
473 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14,
474 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15,
475 };
476
477 /**
478 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
479 *
480 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
481 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
482 *
483 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
484 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
485 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
486 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
487 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
488 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
489 */
490 struct ieee80211_edmg {
491 u8 channels;
492 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
493 };
494
495 /**
496 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
497 *
498 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
499 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
500 *
501 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
502 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
503 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
504 */
505 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
506 bool s1g;
507 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
508 u8 nss_mcs[5];
509 };
510
511 /**
512 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
513 *
514 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
515 * is able to operate in.
516 *
517 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
518 * in this band.
519 * @band: the band this structure represents
520 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
521 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
522 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
523 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
524 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
525 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
526 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
527 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
528 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
529 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
530 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
531 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in
532 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
533 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
534 * iftype_data).
535 */
536 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
537 struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
538 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
539 enum nl80211_band band;
540 int n_channels;
541 int n_bitrates;
542 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
543 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
544 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
545 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
546 u16 n_iftype_data;
547 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
548 };
549
550 /**
551 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
552 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
553 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
554 *
555 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
556 */
557 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)558 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
559 u8 iftype)
560 {
561 int i;
562
563 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
564 return NULL;
565
566 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
567 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
568
569 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++) {
570 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
571 &sband->iftype_data[i];
572
573 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
574 return data;
575 }
576
577 return NULL;
578 }
579
580 /**
581 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
582 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
583 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
584 *
585 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
586 */
587 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)588 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
589 u8 iftype)
590 {
591 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
592 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
593
594 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
595 return &data->he_cap;
596
597 return NULL;
598 }
599
600 /**
601 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
602 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
603 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
604 *
605 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
606 */
607 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)608 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
609 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
610 {
611 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
612 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
613
614 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
615 return 0;
616
617 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
618 }
619
620 /**
621 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
622 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
623 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
624 *
625 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
626 */
627 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)628 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
629 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
630 {
631 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
632 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
633
634 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
635 return &data->eht_cap;
636
637 return NULL;
638 }
639
640 /**
641 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
642 *
643 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
644 *
645 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
646 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
647 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
648 *
649 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
650 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
651 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
652 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
653 * without affecting other devices.
654 *
655 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
656 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
657 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
658 */
659 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
660 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
661 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)662 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
663 {
664 }
665 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
666
667
668 /*
669 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
670 */
671
672 /**
673 * DOC: Actions and configuration
674 *
675 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
676 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
677 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
678 * operations use are described separately.
679 *
680 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
681 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
682 *
683 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
684 * in a separate chapter.
685 */
686
687 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
688 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
689
690 /**
691 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
692 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
693 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
694 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
695 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
696 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
697 * determine the address as needed.
698 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
699 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating
700 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC.
701 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
702 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
703 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
704 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
705 */
706 struct vif_params {
707 u32 flags;
708 int use_4addr;
709 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
710 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
711 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
712 };
713
714 /**
715 * struct key_params - key information
716 *
717 * Information about a key
718 *
719 * @key: key material
720 * @key_len: length of key material
721 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
722 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
723 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
724 * length given by @seq_len.
725 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
726 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
727 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
728 */
729 struct key_params {
730 const u8 *key;
731 const u8 *seq;
732 int key_len;
733 int seq_len;
734 u16 vlan_id;
735 u32 cipher;
736 enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
737 };
738
739 /**
740 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
741 * @chan: the (control) channel
742 * @width: channel width
743 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
744 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
745 * (only with 80+80 MHz)
746 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
747 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
748 * chan will define the primary channel and all other
749 * parameters are ignored.
750 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
751 */
752 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
753 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
754 enum nl80211_chan_width width;
755 u32 center_freq1;
756 u32 center_freq2;
757 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
758 u16 freq1_offset;
759 };
760
761 /*
762 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
763 */
764 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
765 struct {
766 u32 legacy;
767 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
768 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
769 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
770 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
771 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
772 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
773 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
774 };
775
776
777 /**
778 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
779 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
780 * of the peer.
781 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
782 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
783 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
784 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
785 * @retry_long: retry count value
786 * @retry_short: retry count value
787 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
788 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
789 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
790 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
791 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
792 */
793 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
794 bool config_override;
795 u8 tids;
796 u64 mask;
797 enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
798 u8 retry_long, retry_short;
799 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
800 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
801 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
802 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
803 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
804 };
805
806 /**
807 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
808 * @peer: Station's MAC address
809 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
810 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
811 */
812 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
813 const u8 *peer;
814 u32 n_tid_conf;
815 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
816 };
817
818 /**
819 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
820 * @macaddr: STA MAC address
821 * @kek: FILS KEK
822 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
823 * @snonce: STA Nonce
824 * @anonce: AP Nonce
825 */
826 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
827 const u8 *macaddr;
828 const u8 *kek;
829 u8 kek_len;
830 const u8 *snonce;
831 const u8 *anonce;
832 };
833
834 /**
835 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
836 * @chandef: the channel definition
837 *
838 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
839 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
840 */
841 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)842 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
843 {
844 switch (chandef->width) {
845 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
846 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
847 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
848 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
849 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
850 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
851 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
852 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
853 default:
854 WARN_ON(1);
855 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
856 }
857 }
858
859 /**
860 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
861 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
862 * @channel: the control channel
863 * @chantype: the channel type
864 *
865 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
866 */
867 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
868 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
869 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
870
871 /**
872 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
873 * @chandef1: first channel definition
874 * @chandef2: second channel definition
875 *
876 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
877 * identical, %false otherwise.
878 */
879 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)880 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
881 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
882 {
883 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
884 chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
885 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
886 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
887 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
888 }
889
890 /**
891 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
892 *
893 * @chandef: the channel definition
894 *
895 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
896 */
897 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)898 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
899 {
900 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
901 }
902
903 /**
904 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
905 * @chandef1: first channel definition
906 * @chandef2: second channel definition
907 *
908 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
909 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
910 */
911 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
912 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
913 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
914
915 /**
916 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
917 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
918 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
919 */
920 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
921
922 /**
923 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
924 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
925 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
926 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
927 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
928 */
929 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
930 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
931 u32 prohibited_flags);
932
933 /**
934 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
935 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
936 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
937 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
938 * Returns:
939 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
940 */
941 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
942 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
943 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
944
945 /**
946 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
947 * @width: the channel width of the channel
948 *
949 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
950 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
951 *
952 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
953 */
954 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)955 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
956 {
957 switch (width) {
958 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
959 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
960 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
961 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
962 default:
963 break;
964 }
965 return 0;
966 }
967
968 /**
969 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
970 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
971 *
972 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
973 *
974 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
975 */
976 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)977 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
978 {
979 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
980 }
981
982 /**
983 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
984 *
985 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
986 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
987 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
988 *
989 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
990 *
991 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
992 */
993 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)994 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
995 {
996 switch (chandef->width) {
997 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
998 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
999 chandef->chan->max_power);
1000 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1001 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1002 chandef->chan->max_power);
1003 default:
1004 break;
1005 }
1006 return chandef->chan->max_power;
1007 }
1008
1009 /**
1010 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1011 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1012 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1013 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1014 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1015 */
1016 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1017 unsigned long band_mask,
1018 u32 prohibited_flags);
1019
1020 /**
1021 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1022 *
1023 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1024 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1025 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1026 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1027 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1028 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1029 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1030 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1031 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1032 *
1033 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1034 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1035 */
1036 enum survey_info_flags {
1037 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0),
1038 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1),
1039 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2),
1040 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3),
1041 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4),
1042 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5),
1043 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6),
1044 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7),
1045 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8),
1046 };
1047
1048 /**
1049 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1050 *
1051 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1052 * record to report global statistics
1053 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1054 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1055 * optional
1056 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1057 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1058 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1059 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1060 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1061 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1062 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1063 *
1064 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1065 *
1066 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1067 * channel duty cycle etc.
1068 */
1069 struct survey_info {
1070 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1071 u64 time;
1072 u64 time_busy;
1073 u64 time_ext_busy;
1074 u64 time_rx;
1075 u64 time_tx;
1076 u64 time_scan;
1077 u64 time_bss_rx;
1078 u32 filled;
1079 s8 noise;
1080 };
1081
1082 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS 4
1083 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10
1084
1085 /**
1086 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1087 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1088 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1089 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1090 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1091 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1092 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1093 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1094 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1095 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1096 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1097 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1098 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1099 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1100 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1101 * protocol frames.
1102 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1103 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1104 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1105 * port for mac80211
1106 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1107 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1108 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1109 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1110 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1111 * offload)
1112 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1113 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1114 *
1115 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1116 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1117 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1118 * such a scenario.
1119 *
1120 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1121 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1122 *
1123 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1124 * Allow hash-to-element only
1125 *
1126 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1127 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1128 */
1129 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1130 u32 wpa_versions;
1131 u32 cipher_group;
1132 int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1133 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1134 int n_akm_suites;
1135 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1136 bool control_port;
1137 __be16 control_port_ethertype;
1138 bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1139 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1140 bool control_port_no_preauth;
1141 struct key_params *wep_keys;
1142 int wep_tx_key;
1143 const u8 *psk;
1144 const u8 *sae_pwd;
1145 u8 sae_pwd_len;
1146 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1147
1148 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1149 };
1150
1151 /**
1152 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1153 *
1154 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1155 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1156 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1157 */
1158 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1159 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1160 u8 index;
1161 bool ema;
1162 };
1163
1164 /**
1165 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1166 *
1167 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1168 *
1169 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1170 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1171 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1172 */
1173 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1174 u8 cnt;
1175 struct {
1176 const u8 *data;
1177 size_t len;
1178 } elem[];
1179 };
1180
1181 /**
1182 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1183 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1184 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1185 * or %NULL if not changed
1186 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1187 * or %NULL if not changed
1188 * @head_len: length of @head
1189 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1190 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1191 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1192 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1193 * frames or %NULL
1194 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1195 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1196 * Response frames or %NULL
1197 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1198 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1199 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1200 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1201 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1202 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1203 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1204 * (measurement type 8)
1205 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1206 * Token (measurement type 11)
1207 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1208 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1209 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1210 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1211 * attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1212 */
1213 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1214 unsigned int link_id;
1215
1216 const u8 *head, *tail;
1217 const u8 *beacon_ies;
1218 const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1219 const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1220 const u8 *probe_resp;
1221 const u8 *lci;
1222 const u8 *civicloc;
1223 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1224 s8 ftm_responder;
1225
1226 size_t head_len, tail_len;
1227 size_t beacon_ies_len;
1228 size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1229 size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1230 size_t probe_resp_len;
1231 size_t lci_len;
1232 size_t civicloc_len;
1233 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1234 bool he_bss_color_valid;
1235
1236 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1237 };
1238
1239 struct mac_address {
1240 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1241 };
1242
1243 /**
1244 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1245 *
1246 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1247 * entry specified by mac_addr
1248 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1249 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1250 */
1251 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1252 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1253 int n_acl_entries;
1254
1255 /* Keep it last */
1256 struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1257 };
1258
1259 /**
1260 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1261 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1262 *
1263 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1264 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1265 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1266 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1267 * frame headers.
1268 */
1269 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1270 u32 min_interval;
1271 u32 max_interval;
1272 size_t tmpl_len;
1273 const u8 *tmpl;
1274 };
1275
1276 /**
1277 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1278 * response parameters in 6GHz.
1279 *
1280 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1281 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1282 * scanning
1283 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1284 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1285 */
1286 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1287 u32 interval;
1288 size_t tmpl_len;
1289 const u8 *tmpl;
1290 };
1291
1292 /**
1293 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1294 *
1295 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1296 *
1297 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1298 * @beacon: beacon data
1299 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1300 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1301 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1302 * user space)
1303 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1304 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1305 * @crypto: crypto settings
1306 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1307 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1308 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1309 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1310 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1311 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1312 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1313 * MAC address based access control
1314 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1315 * networks.
1316 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1317 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1318 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1319 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1320 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1321 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1322 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1323 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1324 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1325 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1326 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1327 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1328 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1329 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1330 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1331 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1332 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1333 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1334 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1335 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1336 */
1337 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1338 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1339
1340 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1341
1342 int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1343 const u8 *ssid;
1344 size_t ssid_len;
1345 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1346 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1347 bool privacy;
1348 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1349 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1350 int inactivity_timeout;
1351 u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1352 bool p2p_opp_ps;
1353 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1354 bool pbss;
1355 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1356
1357 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1358 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1359 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1360 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1361 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1362 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1363 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1364 bool twt_responder;
1365 u32 flags;
1366 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1367 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1368 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1369 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1370 u16 punct_bitmap;
1371
1372 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1373 };
1374
1375 /**
1376 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1377 *
1378 * Used for channel switch
1379 *
1380 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1381 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1382 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1383 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1384 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1385 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1386 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1387 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1388 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1389 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1390 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents
1391 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel.
1392 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured.
1393 */
1394 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1395 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1396 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1397 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1398 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1399 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1400 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1401 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1402 bool radar_required;
1403 bool block_tx;
1404 u8 count;
1405 u16 punct_bitmap;
1406
1407 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1408 };
1409
1410 /**
1411 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1412 *
1413 * Used for bss color change
1414 *
1415 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1416 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1417 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1418 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1419 * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1420 * @color: the color used after the change
1421 */
1422 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1423 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1424 u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1425 u16 counter_offset_presp;
1426 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1427 u8 count;
1428 u8 color;
1429 };
1430
1431 /**
1432 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1433 *
1434 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1435 *
1436 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1437 * to use for verification
1438 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1439 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1440 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1441 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1442 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1443 * nl80211_iftype.
1444 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1445 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1446 * the verification
1447 */
1448 struct iface_combination_params {
1449 int num_different_channels;
1450 u8 radar_detect;
1451 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1452 u32 new_beacon_int;
1453 };
1454
1455 /**
1456 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1457 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1458 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1459 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1460 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER: apply tx power for STA
1461 *
1462 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1463 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1464 */
1465 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1466 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1467 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1468 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1469 };
1470
1471 /**
1472 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1473 *
1474 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1475 *
1476 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1477 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1478 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1479 * power per-interface or per-station.
1480 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1481 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1482 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1483 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1484 * per peer TPC.
1485 */
1486 struct sta_txpwr {
1487 s16 power;
1488 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1489 };
1490
1491 /**
1492 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1493 *
1494 * Used to change and create a new link station.
1495 *
1496 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1497 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1498 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1499 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1500 * (or NULL for no change)
1501 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1502 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1503 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1504 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1505 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1506 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1507 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1508 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1509 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1510 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1511 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1512 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1513 */
1514 struct link_station_parameters {
1515 const u8 *mld_mac;
1516 int link_id;
1517 const u8 *link_mac;
1518 const u8 *supported_rates;
1519 u8 supported_rates_len;
1520 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1521 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1522 u8 opmode_notif;
1523 bool opmode_notif_used;
1524 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1525 u8 he_capa_len;
1526 struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1527 bool txpwr_set;
1528 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1529 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1530 u8 eht_capa_len;
1531
1532 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1533 };
1534
1535 /**
1536 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1537 *
1538 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1539 *
1540 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1541 * @link_id: the link id
1542 */
1543 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1544 const u8 *mld_mac;
1545 u32 link_id;
1546 };
1547
1548 /**
1549 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1550 *
1551 * Used to change and create a new station.
1552 *
1553 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1554 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1555 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1556 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1557 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1558 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1559 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1560 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1561 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1562 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1563 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1564 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1565 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1566 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1567 * QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1568 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1569 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1570 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1571 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1572 * to unknown)
1573 * @capability: station capability
1574 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1575 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1576 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1577 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1578 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1579 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1580 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1581 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1582 * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1583 */
1584 struct station_parameters {
1585 struct net_device *vlan;
1586 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1587 u32 sta_modify_mask;
1588 int listen_interval;
1589 u16 aid;
1590 u16 vlan_id;
1591 u16 peer_aid;
1592 u8 plink_action;
1593 u8 plink_state;
1594 u8 uapsd_queues;
1595 u8 max_sp;
1596 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1597 u16 capability;
1598 const u8 *ext_capab;
1599 u8 ext_capab_len;
1600 const u8 *supported_channels;
1601 u8 supported_channels_len;
1602 const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1603 u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1604 int support_p2p_ps;
1605 u16 airtime_weight;
1606 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1607 };
1608
1609 /**
1610 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1611 *
1612 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1613 *
1614 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1615 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1616 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1617 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1618 */
1619 struct station_del_parameters {
1620 const u8 *mac;
1621 u8 subtype;
1622 u16 reason_code;
1623 };
1624
1625 /**
1626 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1627 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1628 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1629 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1630 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1631 * the AP MLME in the device
1632 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1633 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1634 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1635 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1636 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1637 * supported/used)
1638 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1639 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1640 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1641 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1642 */
1643 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1644 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1645 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1646 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1647 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1648 CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1649 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1650 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1651 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1652 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1653 };
1654
1655 /**
1656 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1657 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1658 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1659 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1660 *
1661 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1662 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1663 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1664 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1665 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1666 */
1667 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1668 struct station_parameters *params,
1669 enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1670
1671 /**
1672 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1673 *
1674 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1675 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1676 *
1677 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1678 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1679 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1680 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1681 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1682 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1683 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1684 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1685 */
1686 enum rate_info_flags {
1687 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0),
1688 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1),
1689 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1690 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3),
1691 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4),
1692 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5),
1693 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6),
1694 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7),
1695 };
1696
1697 /**
1698 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1699 *
1700 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1701 *
1702 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1703 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1704 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1705 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1706 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1707 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1708 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1709 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1710 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1711 */
1712 enum rate_info_bw {
1713 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1714 RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1715 RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1716 RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1717 RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1718 RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1719 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1720 RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1721 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1722 };
1723
1724 /**
1725 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1726 *
1727 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1728 *
1729 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1730 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1731 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1732 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1733 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1734 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1735 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1736 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1737 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1738 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1739 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1740 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1741 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1742 */
1743 struct rate_info {
1744 u8 flags;
1745 u8 mcs;
1746 u16 legacy;
1747 u8 nss;
1748 u8 bw;
1749 u8 he_gi;
1750 u8 he_dcm;
1751 u8 he_ru_alloc;
1752 u8 n_bonded_ch;
1753 u8 eht_gi;
1754 u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1755 };
1756
1757 /**
1758 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1759 *
1760 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1761 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1762 *
1763 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1764 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1765 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1766 */
1767 enum bss_param_flags {
1768 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0,
1769 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1,
1770 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2,
1771 };
1772
1773 /**
1774 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1775 *
1776 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1777 *
1778 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1779 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1780 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1781 */
1782 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1783 u8 flags;
1784 u8 dtim_period;
1785 u16 beacon_interval;
1786 };
1787
1788 /**
1789 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1790 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1791 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1792 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1793 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1794 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1795 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1796 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1797 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1798 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1799 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1800 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1801 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1802 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1803 */
1804 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1805 u32 filled;
1806 u32 backlog_bytes;
1807 u32 backlog_packets;
1808 u32 flows;
1809 u32 drops;
1810 u32 ecn_marks;
1811 u32 overlimit;
1812 u32 overmemory;
1813 u32 collisions;
1814 u32 tx_bytes;
1815 u32 tx_packets;
1816 u32 max_flows;
1817 };
1818
1819 /**
1820 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1821 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1822 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1823 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1824 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1825 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1826 * transmitted MSDUs
1827 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1828 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1829 */
1830 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1831 u32 filled;
1832 u64 rx_msdu;
1833 u64 tx_msdu;
1834 u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1835 u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1836 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1837 };
1838
1839 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4
1840
1841 /**
1842 * struct station_info - station information
1843 *
1844 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1845 *
1846 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1847 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1848 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1849 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1850 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1851 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1852 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1853 * @llid: mesh local link id
1854 * @plid: mesh peer link id
1855 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1856 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1857 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1858 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1859 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1860 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1861 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1862 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1863 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1864 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1865 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1866 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1867 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1868 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1869 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason.
1870 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1871 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1872 * This number should increase every time the list of stations
1873 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1874 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1875 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1876 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1877 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1878 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1879 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1880 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1881 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1882 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1883 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1884 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1885 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1886 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1887 * towards this station.
1888 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1889 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1890 * from this peer
1891 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1892 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1893 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1894 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1895 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1896 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1897 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1898 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1899 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1900 * been sent.
1901 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1902 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1903 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1904 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1905 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1906 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1907 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
1908 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
1909 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
1910 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
1911 * dump_station() callbacks.
1912 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
1913 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
1914 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
1915 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
1916 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
1917 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
1918 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
1919 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
1920 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
1921 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
1922 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
1923 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
1924 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
1925 */
1926 struct station_info {
1927 u64 filled;
1928 u32 connected_time;
1929 u32 inactive_time;
1930 u64 assoc_at;
1931 u64 rx_bytes;
1932 u64 tx_bytes;
1933 u16 llid;
1934 u16 plid;
1935 u8 plink_state;
1936 s8 signal;
1937 s8 signal_avg;
1938
1939 u8 chains;
1940 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1941 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1942
1943 struct rate_info txrate;
1944 struct rate_info rxrate;
1945 u32 rx_packets;
1946 u32 tx_packets;
1947 u32 tx_retries;
1948 u32 tx_failed;
1949 u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1950 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1951 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1952
1953 int generation;
1954
1955 const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1956 size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1957
1958 u32 beacon_loss_count;
1959 s64 t_offset;
1960 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1961 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1962 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1963
1964 u32 expected_throughput;
1965
1966 u64 tx_duration;
1967 u64 rx_duration;
1968 u64 rx_beacon;
1969 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1970 u8 connected_to_gate;
1971
1972 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1973 s8 ack_signal;
1974 s8 avg_ack_signal;
1975
1976 u16 airtime_weight;
1977
1978 u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1979 u32 fcs_err_count;
1980
1981 u32 airtime_link_metric;
1982
1983 u8 connected_to_as;
1984
1985 bool mlo_params_valid;
1986 u8 assoc_link_id;
1987 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1988 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
1989 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
1990
1991 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
1992 };
1993
1994 /**
1995 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
1996 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
1997 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
1998 */
1999 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2000 s32 power;
2001 u32 freq_range_index;
2002 };
2003
2004 /**
2005 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2006 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2007 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2008 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2009 */
2010 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2011 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2012 u32 num_sub_specs;
2013 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
2014 };
2015
2016
2017 /**
2018 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2019 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency
2020 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency
2021 */
2022 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2023 u32 start_freq;
2024 u32 end_freq;
2025 };
2026
2027 /**
2028 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2029 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2030 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2031 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2032 *
2033 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2034 * range to small ones and then append them.
2035 */
2036 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2037 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2038 u32 num_freq_ranges;
2039 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2040 };
2041
2042 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2043 /**
2044 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2045 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2046 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2047 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2048 *
2049 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2050 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2051 * considered undefined.
2052 */
2053 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2054 struct station_info *sinfo);
2055 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2056 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2057 const u8 *mac_addr,
2058 struct station_info *sinfo)
2059 {
2060 return -ENOENT;
2061 }
2062 #endif
2063
2064 /**
2065 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2066 *
2067 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2068 * according to the nl80211 flags.
2069 *
2070 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2071 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2072 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2073 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2074 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2075 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2076 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2077 */
2078 enum monitor_flags {
2079 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
2080 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
2081 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
2082 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
2083 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
2084 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
2085 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
2086 };
2087
2088 /**
2089 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags
2090 *
2091 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2092 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2093 *
2094 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2095 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2096 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2097 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2098 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2099 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2100 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2101 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2102 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2103 */
2104 enum mpath_info_flags {
2105 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0),
2106 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1),
2107 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2),
2108 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3),
2109 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4),
2110 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5),
2111 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6),
2112 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7),
2113 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8),
2114 };
2115
2116 /**
2117 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2118 *
2119 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2120 *
2121 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2122 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2123 * @sn: target sequence number
2124 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2125 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2126 * @flags: mesh path flags
2127 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2128 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2129 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2130 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2131 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2132 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2133 * @hop_count: hops to destination
2134 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2135 */
2136 struct mpath_info {
2137 u32 filled;
2138 u32 frame_qlen;
2139 u32 sn;
2140 u32 metric;
2141 u32 exptime;
2142 u32 discovery_timeout;
2143 u8 discovery_retries;
2144 u8 flags;
2145 u8 hop_count;
2146 u32 path_change_count;
2147
2148 int generation;
2149 };
2150
2151 /**
2152 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2153 *
2154 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2155 *
2156 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2157 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2158 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2159 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2160 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2161 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2162 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2163 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2164 * (or NULL for no change)
2165 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2166 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2167 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2168 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2169 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2170 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2171 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2172 */
2173 struct bss_parameters {
2174 int link_id;
2175 int use_cts_prot;
2176 int use_short_preamble;
2177 int use_short_slot_time;
2178 const u8 *basic_rates;
2179 u8 basic_rates_len;
2180 int ap_isolate;
2181 int ht_opmode;
2182 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2183 };
2184
2185 /**
2186 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2187 *
2188 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2189 *
2190 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2191 * by the Mesh Peering Open message
2192 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2193 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2194 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2195 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2196 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2197 * mesh interface
2198 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2199 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2200 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2201 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2202 * elements
2203 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2204 * detect compatible mesh peers
2205 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2206 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2207 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2208 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2209 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2210 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2211 * a path discovery in milliseconds
2212 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2213 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2214 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2215 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2216 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2217 * element
2218 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2219 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2220 * element
2221 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2222 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2223 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2224 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2225 * announcements are transmitted
2226 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2227 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2228 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2229 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2230 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2231 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2232 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2233 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2234 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2235 * station to establish a peer link
2236 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2237 *
2238 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2239 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2240 * the root mesh STA to be valid.
2241 *
2242 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2243 * PREQs are transmitted.
2244 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2245 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2246 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2247 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2248 * setting for new peer links.
2249 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2250 * after transmitting its beacon.
2251 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2252 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2253 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes.
2254 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2255 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2256 * in the mesh formation field.
2257 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2258 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the
2259 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2260 * in the mesh path table
2261 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2262 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2263 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2264 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2265 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2266 */
2267 struct mesh_config {
2268 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2269 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2270 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2271 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2272 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2273 u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2274 u8 element_ttl;
2275 bool auto_open_plinks;
2276 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2277 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2278 u32 path_refresh_time;
2279 u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2280 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2281 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2282 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2283 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2284 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2285 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2286 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2287 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2288 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2289 bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2290 s32 rssi_threshold;
2291 u16 ht_opmode;
2292 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2293 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2294 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2295 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2296 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2297 u32 plink_timeout;
2298 bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2299
2300 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2301 };
2302
2303 /**
2304 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2305 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2306 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2307 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2308 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2309 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2310 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2311 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2312 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2313 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2314 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2315 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2316 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2317 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2318 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2319 * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2320 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2321 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2322 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2323 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2324 * to operate on DFS channels.
2325 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2326 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2327 *
2328 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2329 */
2330 struct mesh_setup {
2331 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2332 const u8 *mesh_id;
2333 u8 mesh_id_len;
2334 u8 sync_method;
2335 u8 path_sel_proto;
2336 u8 path_metric;
2337 u8 auth_id;
2338 const u8 *ie;
2339 u8 ie_len;
2340 bool is_authenticated;
2341 bool is_secure;
2342 bool user_mpm;
2343 u8 dtim_period;
2344 u16 beacon_interval;
2345 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2346 u32 basic_rates;
2347 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2348 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2349 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2350
2351 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2352 };
2353
2354 /**
2355 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2356 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2357 *
2358 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2359 */
2360 struct ocb_setup {
2361 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2362 };
2363
2364 /**
2365 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2366 * @ac: AC identifier
2367 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2368 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2369 * 1..32767]
2370 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2371 * 1..32767]
2372 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2373 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2374 */
2375 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2376 enum nl80211_ac ac;
2377 u16 txop;
2378 u16 cwmin;
2379 u16 cwmax;
2380 u8 aifs;
2381 int link_id;
2382 };
2383
2384 /**
2385 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2386 *
2387 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2388 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2389 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2390 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2391 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2392 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2393 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2394 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2395 * in the wiphy structure.
2396 *
2397 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2398 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2399 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2400 *
2401 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2402 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2403 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2404 * to userspace.
2405 */
2406
2407 /**
2408 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2409 * @ssid: the SSID
2410 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2411 */
2412 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2413 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2414 u8 ssid_len;
2415 };
2416
2417 /**
2418 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2419 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2420 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2421 * information is not available, this field is left zero.
2422 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2423 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2424 * userspace will be notified of that
2425 */
2426 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2427 u64 scan_start_tsf;
2428 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2429 bool aborted;
2430 };
2431
2432 /**
2433 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2434 *
2435 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2436 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2437 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2438 * which the above info relvant to
2439 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2440 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2441 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2442 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2443 */
2444 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2445 u32 short_ssid;
2446 u32 channel_idx;
2447 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2448 bool unsolicited_probe;
2449 bool short_ssid_valid;
2450 bool psc_no_listen;
2451 };
2452
2453 /**
2454 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2455 *
2456 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2457 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2458 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2459 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2460 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2461 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2462 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2463 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2464 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2465 * the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2466 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2467 * %duration field.
2468 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2469 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2470 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2471 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2472 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2473 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2474 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2475 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2476 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2477 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2478 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2479 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2480 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2481 * true if this is the second scan request
2482 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2483 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2484 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2485 */
2486 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2487 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2488 int n_ssids;
2489 u32 n_channels;
2490 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2491 const u8 *ie;
2492 size_t ie_len;
2493 u16 duration;
2494 bool duration_mandatory;
2495 u32 flags;
2496
2497 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2498
2499 struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2500
2501 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2502 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2503 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2504
2505 /* internal */
2506 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2507 unsigned long scan_start;
2508 struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2509 bool notified;
2510 bool no_cck;
2511 bool scan_6ghz;
2512 u32 n_6ghz_params;
2513 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2514
2515 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2516
2517 /* keep last */
2518 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2519 };
2520
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2521 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2522 {
2523 int i;
2524
2525 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2526 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2527 buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2528 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2529 }
2530 }
2531
2532 /**
2533 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2534 *
2535 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2536 * or no match (RSSI only)
2537 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2538 * or no match (RSSI only)
2539 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2540 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2541 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2542 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2543 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2544 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2545 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2546 * corresponding matchset.
2547 */
2548 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2549 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2550 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2551 s32 rssi_thold;
2552 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2553 };
2554
2555 /**
2556 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2557 *
2558 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2559 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2560 * infinite loop.
2561 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2562 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2563 */
2564 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2565 u32 interval;
2566 u32 iterations;
2567 };
2568
2569 /**
2570 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2571 *
2572 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2573 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2574 */
2575 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2576 enum nl80211_band band;
2577 s8 delta;
2578 };
2579
2580 /**
2581 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2582 *
2583 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2584 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2585 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2586 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2587 * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2588 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2589 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2590 * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2591 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2592 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2593 * (others are filtered out).
2594 * If ommited, all results are passed.
2595 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2596 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2597 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2598 * @dev: the interface
2599 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2600 * @channels: channels to scan
2601 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2602 * contains the minimum over all matchsets
2603 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2604 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2605 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2606 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2607 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2608 * index must be executed first.
2609 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2610 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2611 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2612 * owned by a particular socket)
2613 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2614 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2615 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2616 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2617 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2618 * supported.
2619 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2620 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2621 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2622 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2623 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2624 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2625 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2626 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2627 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2628 * comparisions.
2629 */
2630 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2631 u64 reqid;
2632 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2633 int n_ssids;
2634 u32 n_channels;
2635 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2636 const u8 *ie;
2637 size_t ie_len;
2638 u32 flags;
2639 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2640 int n_match_sets;
2641 s32 min_rssi_thold;
2642 u32 delay;
2643 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2644 int n_scan_plans;
2645
2646 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2647 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2648
2649 bool relative_rssi_set;
2650 s8 relative_rssi;
2651 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2652
2653 /* internal */
2654 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2655 struct net_device *dev;
2656 unsigned long scan_start;
2657 bool report_results;
2658 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2659 u32 owner_nlportid;
2660 bool nl_owner_dead;
2661 struct list_head list;
2662
2663 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2664
2665 /* keep last */
2666 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2667 };
2668
2669 /**
2670 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2671 *
2672 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2673 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2674 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2675 */
2676 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2677 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2678 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2679 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2680 };
2681
2682 /**
2683 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2684 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2685 * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2686 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2687 * signal type
2688 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2689 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2690 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2691 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2692 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2693 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2694 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2695 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2696 * by %parent_bssid.
2697 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2698 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2699 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2700 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2701 */
2702 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2703 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2704 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2705 s32 signal;
2706 u64 boottime_ns;
2707 u64 parent_tsf;
2708 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2709 u8 chains;
2710 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2711 };
2712
2713 /**
2714 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2715 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2716 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2717 * @len: length of the IEs
2718 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2719 * @data: IE data
2720 */
2721 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2722 u64 tsf;
2723 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2724 int len;
2725 bool from_beacon;
2726 u8 data[];
2727 };
2728
2729 /**
2730 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2731 *
2732 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2733 * for use in scan results and similar.
2734 *
2735 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2736 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2737 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2738 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2739 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2740 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2741 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2742 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2743 * received. It is always non-%NULL.
2744 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2745 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2746 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2747 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2748 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2749 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2750 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2751 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2752 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2753 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2754 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2755 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2756 * (multi-BSSID support)
2757 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2758 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2759 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2760 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2761 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2762 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2763 */
2764 struct cfg80211_bss {
2765 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2766 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2767
2768 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2769 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2770 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2771
2772 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2773 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2774 struct list_head nontrans_list;
2775
2776 s32 signal;
2777
2778 u16 beacon_interval;
2779 u16 capability;
2780
2781 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2782 u8 chains;
2783 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2784
2785 u8 bssid_index;
2786 u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2787
2788 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2789
2790 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2791 };
2792
2793 /**
2794 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2795 * @bss: the bss to search
2796 * @id: the element ID
2797 *
2798 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2799 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2800 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2801 */
2802 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2803
2804 /**
2805 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2806 * @bss: the bss to search
2807 * @id: the element ID
2808 *
2809 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2810 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2811 * Return: %NULL if not found.
2812 */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)2813 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2814 {
2815 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2816 }
2817
2818
2819 /**
2820 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2821 *
2822 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2823 * authentication.
2824 *
2825 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2826 * to it if it needs to keep it.
2827 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2828 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2829 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2830 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2831 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2832 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2833 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2834 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2835 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2836 * transaction sequence number field.
2837 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2838 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
2839 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
2840 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
2841 * given an MLD address) by the driver
2842 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
2843 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
2844 */
2845 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2846 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2847 const u8 *ie;
2848 size_t ie_len;
2849 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2850 const u8 *key;
2851 u8 key_len;
2852 s8 key_idx;
2853 const u8 *auth_data;
2854 size_t auth_data_len;
2855 s8 link_id;
2856 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
2857 };
2858
2859 /**
2860 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
2861 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
2862 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
2863 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
2864 * @elems_len: length of the elements
2865 */
2866 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
2867 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2868 const u8 *elems;
2869 size_t elems_len;
2870 };
2871
2872 /**
2873 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2874 *
2875 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n)
2876 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT
2877 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2878 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2879 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2880 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2881 * request (connect callback).
2882 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE
2883 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT
2884 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
2885 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
2886 * flag is not set.
2887 */
2888 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2889 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0),
2890 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1),
2891 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2),
2892 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3),
2893 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4),
2894 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5),
2895 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6),
2896 };
2897
2898 /**
2899 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2900 *
2901 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2902 * (re)association.
2903 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2904 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2905 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2906 * association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2907 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
2908 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
2909 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2910 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2911 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2912 * @crypto: crypto settings
2913 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2914 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2915 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2916 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2917 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2918 * frame.
2919 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2920 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
2921 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
2922 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2923 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2924 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2925 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2926 * %NULL if FILS is not used.
2927 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2928 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2929 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2930 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2931 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2932 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2933 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
2934 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
2935 * the link on which the association request should be sent
2936 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
2937 * valid iff @link_id >= 0
2938 */
2939 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2940 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2941 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2942 size_t ie_len;
2943 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2944 bool use_mfp;
2945 u32 flags;
2946 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2947 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2948 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2949 const u8 *fils_kek;
2950 size_t fils_kek_len;
2951 const u8 *fils_nonces;
2952 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2953 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2954 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
2955 s8 link_id;
2956
2957 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
2958 };
2959
2960 /**
2961 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2962 *
2963 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2964 * deauthentication.
2965 *
2966 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
2967 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2968 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2969 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2970 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2971 * do not set a deauth frame
2972 */
2973 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2974 const u8 *bssid;
2975 const u8 *ie;
2976 size_t ie_len;
2977 u16 reason_code;
2978 bool local_state_change;
2979 };
2980
2981 /**
2982 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2983 *
2984 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2985 * disassociation.
2986 *
2987 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
2988 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2989 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2990 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2991 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2992 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2993 */
2994 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2995 const u8 *ap_addr;
2996 const u8 *ie;
2997 size_t ie_len;
2998 u16 reason_code;
2999 bool local_state_change;
3000 };
3001
3002 /**
3003 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3004 *
3005 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3006 * method.
3007 *
3008 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3009 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3010 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3011 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3012 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3013 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3014 * IBSSs to join on other channels.
3015 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3016 * @ie_len: length of that
3017 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3018 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3019 * after joining
3020 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3021 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3022 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3023 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3024 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3025 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3026 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3027 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3028 * to operate on DFS channels.
3029 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3030 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3031 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3032 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3033 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3034 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3035 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3036 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3037 */
3038 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3039 const u8 *ssid;
3040 const u8 *bssid;
3041 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3042 const u8 *ie;
3043 u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3044 u16 beacon_interval;
3045 u32 basic_rates;
3046 bool channel_fixed;
3047 bool privacy;
3048 bool control_port;
3049 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3050 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3051 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3052 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3053 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3054 struct key_params *wep_keys;
3055 int wep_tx_key;
3056
3057 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3058 };
3059
3060 /**
3061 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3062 *
3063 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3064 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3065 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3066 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3067 */
3068 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3069 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3070 union {
3071 enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3072 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3073 } param;
3074 };
3075
3076 /**
3077 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3078 *
3079 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3080 * authentication and association.
3081 *
3082 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3083 * on scan results)
3084 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3085 * %NULL if not specified
3086 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3087 * results)
3088 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3089 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3090 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3091 * to use.
3092 * @ssid: SSID
3093 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3094 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3095 * @ie: IEs for association request
3096 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3097 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3098 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3099 * @crypto: crypto settings
3100 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3101 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3102 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3103 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3104 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds
3105 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3106 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3107 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3108 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3109 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides
3110 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3111 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3112 * networks.
3113 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3114 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3115 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3116 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3117 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3118 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3119 * frame.
3120 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3121 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3122 * data IE.
3123 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3124 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3125 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3126 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3127 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3128 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3129 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3130 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3131 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3132 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3133 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3134 * offload of 4-way handshake.
3135 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3136 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3137 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3138 */
3139 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3140 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3141 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3142 const u8 *bssid;
3143 const u8 *bssid_hint;
3144 const u8 *ssid;
3145 size_t ssid_len;
3146 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3147 const u8 *ie;
3148 size_t ie_len;
3149 bool privacy;
3150 enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3151 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3152 const u8 *key;
3153 u8 key_len, key_idx;
3154 u32 flags;
3155 int bg_scan_period;
3156 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3157 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3158 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3159 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3160 bool pbss;
3161 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3162 const u8 *prev_bssid;
3163 const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3164 size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3165 const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3166 size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3167 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3168 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3169 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3170 bool want_1x;
3171 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3172
3173 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3174 };
3175
3176 /**
3177 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3178 *
3179 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3180 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3181 *
3182 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3183 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3184 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3185 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3186 */
3187 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3188 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0),
3189 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1),
3190 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2),
3191 };
3192
3193 /**
3194 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3195 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3196 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3197 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3198 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3199 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3200 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3201 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3202 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3203 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3204 */
3205 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3206 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0,
3207 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1,
3208 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2,
3209 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3,
3210 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4,
3211 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5,
3212 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6,
3213 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7,
3214 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8,
3215 };
3216
3217 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256
3218
3219 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3220 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000
3221 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000
3222
3223 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3224 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000
3225
3226 /**
3227 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3228 *
3229 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3230 * caching.
3231 *
3232 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3233 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3234 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3235 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3236 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3237 * the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3238 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3239 * cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3240 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3241 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3242 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3243 * %NULL).
3244 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3245 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3246 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3247 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3248 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3249 * used for it expires.
3250 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3251 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3252 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3253 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3254 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3255 */
3256 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3257 const u8 *bssid;
3258 const u8 *pmkid;
3259 const u8 *pmk;
3260 size_t pmk_len;
3261 const u8 *ssid;
3262 size_t ssid_len;
3263 const u8 *cache_id;
3264 u32 pmk_lifetime;
3265 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3266 };
3267
3268 /**
3269 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3270 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3271 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3272 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3273 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3274 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3275 *
3276 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3277 * memory, free @mask only!
3278 */
3279 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3280 const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3281 int pattern_len;
3282 int pkt_offset;
3283 };
3284
3285 /**
3286 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3287 *
3288 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3289 * @src: source IP address
3290 * @dst: destination IP address
3291 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3292 * @src_port: source port
3293 * @dst_port: destination port
3294 * @payload_len: data payload length
3295 * @payload: data payload buffer
3296 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3297 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3298 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3299 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3300 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3301 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3302 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3303 */
3304 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3305 struct socket *sock;
3306 __be32 src, dst;
3307 u16 src_port, dst_port;
3308 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3309 int payload_len;
3310 const u8 *payload;
3311 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3312 u32 data_interval;
3313 u32 wake_len;
3314 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3315 u32 tokens_size;
3316 /* must be last, variable member */
3317 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3318 };
3319
3320 /**
3321 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3322 *
3323 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3324 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3325 * operating as normal during suspend
3326 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3327 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3328 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3329 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3330 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3331 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3332 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3333 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3334 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3335 * NULL if not configured.
3336 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3337 */
3338 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3339 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3340 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3341 rfkill_release;
3342 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3343 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3344 int n_patterns;
3345 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3346 };
3347
3348 /**
3349 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3350 *
3351 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3352 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3353 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3354 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3355 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3356 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3357 */
3358 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3359 int delay;
3360 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3361 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3362 int n_patterns;
3363 };
3364
3365 /**
3366 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3367 *
3368 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3369 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3370 * @n_rules: number of rules
3371 */
3372 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3373 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3374 int n_rules;
3375 };
3376
3377 /**
3378 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3379 *
3380 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3381 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This
3382 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3383 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3384 * occurred (in MHz)
3385 */
3386 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3387 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3388 int n_channels;
3389 u32 channels[];
3390 };
3391
3392 /**
3393 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3394 *
3395 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3396 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3397 * match information.
3398 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3399 * the matches that triggered the wake up.
3400 */
3401 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3402 int n_matches;
3403 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3404 };
3405
3406 /**
3407 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3408 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3409 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3410 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3411 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3412 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3413 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3414 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3415 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3416 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3417 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3418 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3419 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3420 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3421 * it is.
3422 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3423 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3424 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3425 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3426 */
3427 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3428 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3429 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3430 rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3431 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3432 s32 pattern_idx;
3433 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3434 const void *packet;
3435 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3436 };
3437
3438 /**
3439 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3440 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3441 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3442 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3443 * @kek_len: length of kek
3444 * @kck_len: length of kck
3445 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3446 */
3447 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3448 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3449 u32 akm;
3450 u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3451 };
3452
3453 /**
3454 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3455 *
3456 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3457 *
3458 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3459 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3460 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3461 */
3462 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3463 u16 md;
3464 const u8 *ie;
3465 size_t ie_len;
3466 };
3467
3468 /**
3469 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3470 *
3471 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3472 *
3473 * @chan: channel to use
3474 * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3475 * @wait: duration for ROC
3476 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3477 * @len: buffer length
3478 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3479 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3480 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3481 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3482 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3483 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3484 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3485 */
3486 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3487 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3488 bool offchan;
3489 unsigned int wait;
3490 const u8 *buf;
3491 size_t len;
3492 bool no_cck;
3493 bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3494 int n_csa_offsets;
3495 const u16 *csa_offsets;
3496 int link_id;
3497 };
3498
3499 /**
3500 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3501 *
3502 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3503 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3504 */
3505 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3506 u8 dscp;
3507 u8 up;
3508 };
3509
3510 /**
3511 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3512 *
3513 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3514 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3515 */
3516 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3517 u8 low;
3518 u8 high;
3519 };
3520
3521 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3522 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21
3523 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16
3524 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3525 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3526
3527 /**
3528 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3529 *
3530 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3531 *
3532 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3533 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3534 * the user priority DSCP range definition
3535 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3536 */
3537 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3538 u8 num_des;
3539 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3540 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3541 };
3542
3543 /**
3544 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3545 *
3546 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3547 *
3548 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3549 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3550 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3551 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3552 */
3553 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3554 u8 master_pref;
3555 u8 bands;
3556 };
3557
3558 /**
3559 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3560 * configuration
3561 *
3562 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3563 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3564 */
3565 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3566 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3567 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3568 };
3569
3570 /**
3571 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3572 *
3573 * @filter: the content of the filter
3574 * @len: the length of the filter
3575 */
3576 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3577 const u8 *filter;
3578 u8 len;
3579 };
3580
3581 /**
3582 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3583 *
3584 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3585 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3586 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3587 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3588 * implementation specific.
3589 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3590 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3591 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3592 * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3593 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3594 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3595 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3596 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3597 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3598 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3599 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3600 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3601 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3602 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3603 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3604 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3605 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3606 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3607 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3608 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3609 */
3610 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3611 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3612 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3613 u8 publish_type;
3614 bool close_range;
3615 bool publish_bcast;
3616 bool subscribe_active;
3617 u8 followup_id;
3618 u8 followup_reqid;
3619 struct mac_address followup_dest;
3620 u32 ttl;
3621 const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3622 u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3623 bool srf_include;
3624 const u8 *srf_bf;
3625 u8 srf_bf_len;
3626 u8 srf_bf_idx;
3627 struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3628 int srf_num_macs;
3629 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3630 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3631 u8 num_tx_filters;
3632 u8 num_rx_filters;
3633 u8 instance_id;
3634 u64 cookie;
3635
3636 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3637 };
3638
3639 /**
3640 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3641 *
3642 * @aa: authenticator address
3643 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3644 * @pmk: the PMK material
3645 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3646 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3647 * holds PMK-R0.
3648 */
3649 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3650 const u8 *aa;
3651 u8 pmk_len;
3652 const u8 *pmk;
3653 const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3654 };
3655
3656 /**
3657 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3658 *
3659 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3660 *
3661 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3662 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3663 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3664 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3665 * authentication response command interface.
3666 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and
3667 * authentication response command interface.
3668 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3669 * authentication request event interface.
3670 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3671 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3672 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3673 * response command interface (user space to driver).
3674 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3675 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3676 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3677 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3678 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3679 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3680 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3681 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3682 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3683 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3684 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3685 * chosen for the authentication.
3686 */
3687 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3688 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3689 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3690 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3691 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3692 u16 status;
3693 const u8 *pmkid;
3694 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3695 };
3696
3697 /**
3698 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3699 *
3700 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3701 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3702 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3703 * answered
3704 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3705 * successfully answered
3706 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3707 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3708 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions
3709 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3710 * of how much time the responder was busy
3711 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3712 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3713 * the responder
3714 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3715 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3716 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3717 */
3718 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3719 u32 filled;
3720 u32 success_num;
3721 u32 partial_num;
3722 u32 failed_num;
3723 u32 asap_num;
3724 u32 non_asap_num;
3725 u64 total_duration_ms;
3726 u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3727 u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3728 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3729 };
3730
3731 /**
3732 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3733 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3734 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3735 * reason than just "failure"
3736 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3737 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3738 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3739 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3740 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3741 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3742 * by the responder
3743 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3744 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3745 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3746 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3747 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3748 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3749 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3750 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3751 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3752 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3753 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3754 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3755 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3756 * the square root of the variance)
3757 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3758 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3759 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3760 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3761 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3762 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3763 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3764 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3765 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3766 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3767 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3768 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3769 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3770 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3771 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3772 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3773 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3774 */
3775 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3776 const u8 *lci;
3777 const u8 *civicloc;
3778 unsigned int lci_len;
3779 unsigned int civicloc_len;
3780 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3781 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3782 s16 burst_index;
3783 u8 busy_retry_time;
3784 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3785 u8 burst_duration;
3786 u8 ftms_per_burst;
3787 s32 rssi_avg;
3788 s32 rssi_spread;
3789 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3790 s64 rtt_avg;
3791 s64 rtt_variance;
3792 s64 rtt_spread;
3793 s64 dist_avg;
3794 s64 dist_variance;
3795 s64 dist_spread;
3796
3797 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3798 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3799 rssi_avg_valid:1,
3800 rssi_spread_valid:1,
3801 tx_rate_valid:1,
3802 rx_rate_valid:1,
3803 rtt_avg_valid:1,
3804 rtt_variance_valid:1,
3805 rtt_spread_valid:1,
3806 dist_avg_valid:1,
3807 dist_variance_valid:1,
3808 dist_spread_valid:1;
3809
3810 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
3811 };
3812
3813 /**
3814 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3815 * @addr: address of the peer
3816 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3817 * measurement was made)
3818 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3819 * @status: status of the measurement
3820 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3821 * reporting partial results always set this flag
3822 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3823 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3824 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3825 * they're all aggregated for userspace.
3826 * @ftm: FTM result
3827 */
3828 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3829 u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3830 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3831
3832 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3833
3834 u8 final:1,
3835 ap_tsf_valid:1;
3836
3837 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3838
3839 union {
3840 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3841 };
3842 };
3843
3844 /**
3845 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3846 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3847 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3848 * @burst_period: burst period to use
3849 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3850 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3851 * @burst_duration: burst duration
3852 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3853 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3854 * @request_lci: request LCI information
3855 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3856 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3857 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3858 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
3859 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3860 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3861 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
3862 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3863 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3864 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3865 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3866 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3867 *
3868 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3869 */
3870 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3871 enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3872 u16 burst_period;
3873 u8 requested:1,
3874 asap:1,
3875 request_lci:1,
3876 request_civicloc:1,
3877 trigger_based:1,
3878 non_trigger_based:1,
3879 lmr_feedback:1;
3880 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3881 u8 burst_duration;
3882 u8 ftms_per_burst;
3883 u8 ftmr_retries;
3884 u8 bss_color;
3885 };
3886
3887 /**
3888 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3889 * @addr: MAC address
3890 * @chandef: channel to use
3891 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3892 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3893 */
3894 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3895 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3896 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3897 u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3898 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3899 };
3900
3901 /**
3902 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3903 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3904 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3905 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3906 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3907 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3908 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3909 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3910 * be taken from the @mac_addr
3911 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3912 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3913 * zero it means there's no timeout
3914 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3915 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3916 */
3917 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3918 u64 cookie;
3919 void *drv_data;
3920 u32 n_peers;
3921 u32 nl_portid;
3922
3923 u32 timeout;
3924
3925 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3926 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3927
3928 struct list_head list;
3929
3930 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3931 };
3932
3933 /**
3934 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3935 *
3936 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3937 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3938 *
3939 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3940 *
3941 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3942 * has to be done.
3943 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3944 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3945 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3946 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3947 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3948 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3949 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3950 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3951 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
3952 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
3953 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
3954 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
3955 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
3956 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
3957 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
3958 * with OWE update event (driver to user space).
3959 */
3960 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3961 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3962 u16 status;
3963 const u8 *ie;
3964 size_t ie_len;
3965 int assoc_link_id;
3966 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3967 };
3968
3969 /**
3970 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3971 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3972 * for the entire device
3973 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3974 * for the given interface
3975 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3976 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3977 * for these subtypes
3978 */
3979 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3980 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3981 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3982 };
3983
3984 /**
3985 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3986 *
3987 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3988 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3989 *
3990 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3991 * on success or a negative error code.
3992 *
3993 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
3994 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
3995 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
3996 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
3997 *
3998 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3999 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4000 * configured for the device.
4001 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4002 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4003 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4004 * the device.
4005 *
4006 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4007 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4008 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4009 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4010 * also set the address member in the wdev.
4011 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4012 *
4013 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4014 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4015 *
4016 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4017 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4018 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4019 *
4020 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4021 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4022 * address is available.
4023 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4024 *
4025 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4026 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4027 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4028 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4029 *
4030 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4031 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4032 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4033 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4034 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4035 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4036 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4037 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4038 *
4039 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4040 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4041 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4042 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4043 * address for MLO pairwise key.
4044 *
4045 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4046 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4047 *
4048 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4049 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4050 *
4051 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4052 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4053 *
4054 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4055 *
4056 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4057 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4058 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4059 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4060 *
4061 * @add_station: Add a new station.
4062 * @del_station: Remove a station
4063 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4064 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4065 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4066 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4067 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4068 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4069 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4070 *
4071 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4072 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4073 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4074 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4075 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4076 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4077 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4078 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4079 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4080 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4081 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4082 *
4083 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4084 *
4085 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4086 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4087 * set, and which to leave alone.
4088 *
4089 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4090 *
4091 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4092 *
4093 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4094 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4095 * join the mesh instead.
4096 *
4097 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4098 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4099 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4100 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4101 *
4102 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4103 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4104 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4105 * the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4106 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4107 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4108 *
4109 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4110 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4111 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4112 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4113 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4114 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4115 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4116 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4117 *
4118 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4119 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4120 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4121 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4122 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4123 * was received.
4124 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4125 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4126 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4127 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4128 * frame instead of Association Request frame.
4129 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4130 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4131 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4132 * indication of requesting reassociation.
4133 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4134 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4135 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4136 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4137 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4138 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4139 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4140 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4141 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4142 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4143 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4144 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4145 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4146 * case connection was already established (invoked with the
4147 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4148 *
4149 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4150 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4151 * to a merge.
4152 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4153 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4154 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4155 *
4156 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4157 * MESH mode)
4158 *
4159 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4160 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4161 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4162 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4163 *
4164 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4165 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4166 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4167 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4168 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4169 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4170 * return 0 if successful
4171 *
4172 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4173 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4174 *
4175 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4176 *
4177 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4178 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4179 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4180 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4181 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4182 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4183 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4184 * the duration value.
4185 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4186 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4187 * frame on another channel
4188 *
4189 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4190 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4191 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4192 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4193 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4194 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4195 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4196 *
4197 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4198 *
4199 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4200 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4201 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4202 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4203 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4204 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4205 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4206 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4207 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4208 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4209 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4210 * disabled.)
4211 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4212 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the
4213 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should
4214 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4215 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4216 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4217 * thresholds.
4218 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4219 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4220 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4221 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4222 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4223 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4224 * stop (when this method returns 0).
4225 *
4226 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4227 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4228 *
4229 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4230 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4231 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4232 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4233 *
4234 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4235 *
4236 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4237 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4238 *
4239 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4240 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4241 *
4242 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4243 *
4244 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4245 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4246 * current monitoring channel.
4247 *
4248 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4249 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4250 *
4251 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4252 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4253 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4254 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4255 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4256 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4257 *
4258 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4259 *
4260 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4261 * was finished on another phy.
4262 *
4263 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4264 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4265 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4266 *
4267 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4268 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4269 * driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4270 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4271 * reliability. This operation can not fail.
4272 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4273 *
4274 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4275 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4276 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4277 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4278 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4279 * as soon as possible.
4280 *
4281 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4282 *
4283 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4284 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4285 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4286 *
4287 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4288 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4289 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4290 * account.
4291 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4292 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4293 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4294 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4295 * rejected)
4296 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4297 *
4298 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4299 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4300 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4301 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4302 *
4303 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4304 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4305 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4306 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4307 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4308 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4309 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4310 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4311 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4312 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4313 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4314 * cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4315 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4316 * provided @nan_func.
4317 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4318 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4319 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4320 * All other parameters must be ignored.
4321 *
4322 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4323 *
4324 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4325 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4326 *
4327 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4328 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4329 * upon which the driver should clear it.
4330 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4331 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4332 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4333 *
4334 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4335 * user space
4336 *
4337 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter
4338 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4339 *
4340 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4341 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4342 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4343 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4344 *
4345 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4346 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4347 * DH IE through this interface.
4348 *
4349 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4350 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4351 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4352 * This callback may sleep.
4353 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4354 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4355 *
4356 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4357 *
4358 * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4359 *
4360 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4361 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4362 * Response frame.
4363 *
4364 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4365 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4366 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4367 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4368 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4369 * radar channel.
4370 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4371 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4372 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4373 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4374 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4375 */
4376 struct cfg80211_ops {
4377 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4378 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4379 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4380
4381 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4382 const char *name,
4383 unsigned char name_assign_type,
4384 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4385 struct vif_params *params);
4386 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4387 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4388 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4389 struct net_device *dev,
4390 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4391 struct vif_params *params);
4392
4393 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4394 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4395 unsigned int link_id);
4396 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4397 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4398 unsigned int link_id);
4399
4400 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4401 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4402 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4403 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4404 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4405 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4406 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4407 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4408 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4409 const u8 *mac_addr);
4410 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4411 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4412 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4413 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4414 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4415 u8 key_index);
4416 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4417 struct net_device *netdev,
4418 int link_id,
4419 u8 key_index);
4420
4421 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4422 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4423 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4424 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
4425 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4426 unsigned int link_id);
4427
4428
4429 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4430 const u8 *mac,
4431 struct station_parameters *params);
4432 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4433 struct station_del_parameters *params);
4434 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4435 const u8 *mac,
4436 struct station_parameters *params);
4437 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4438 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4439 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4440 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4441
4442 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4443 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4444 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4445 const u8 *dst);
4446 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4447 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4448 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4449 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4450 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4451 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4452 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4453 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4454 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4455 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4456 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4457 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4458 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4459 struct net_device *dev,
4460 struct mesh_config *conf);
4461 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4462 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4463 const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4464 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4465 const struct mesh_config *conf,
4466 const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4467 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4468
4469 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4470 struct ocb_setup *setup);
4471 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4472
4473 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4474 struct bss_parameters *params);
4475
4476 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4477 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4478
4479 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4480 struct net_device *dev,
4481 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4482
4483 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4484 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4485
4486 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4487 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4488 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4489
4490 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4491 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4492 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4493 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4494 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4495 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4496 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4497 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4498
4499 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4500 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4501 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4502 struct net_device *dev,
4503 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4504 u32 changed);
4505 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4506 u16 reason_code);
4507
4508 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4509 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4510 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4511
4512 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4513 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4514
4515 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4516
4517 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4518 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4519 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4520 int *dbm);
4521
4522 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4523
4524 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4525 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4526 void *data, int len);
4527 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4528 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4529 void *data, int len);
4530 #endif
4531
4532 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4533 struct net_device *dev,
4534 unsigned int link_id,
4535 const u8 *peer,
4536 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4537
4538 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4539 int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4540
4541 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4542 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4543 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4544 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4545 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4546
4547 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4548 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4549 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4550 unsigned int duration,
4551 u64 *cookie);
4552 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4553 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4554 u64 cookie);
4555
4556 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4557 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4558 u64 *cookie);
4559 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4560 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4561 u64 cookie);
4562
4563 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4564 bool enabled, int timeout);
4565
4566 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4567 struct net_device *dev,
4568 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4569
4570 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4571 struct net_device *dev,
4572 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4573
4574 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4575 struct net_device *dev,
4576 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4577
4578 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4579 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4580 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4581
4582 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4583 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4584
4585 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4586 struct net_device *dev,
4587 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4588 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4589 u64 reqid);
4590
4591 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4592 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4593
4594 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4595 const u8 *peer, u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token,
4596 u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4597 bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4598 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4599 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4600
4601 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4602 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4603
4604 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4605 struct net_device *dev,
4606 u16 noack_map);
4607
4608 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4609 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4610 unsigned int link_id,
4611 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4612
4613 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4614 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4615 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4616 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4617
4618 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4619 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4620
4621 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4622 struct net_device *dev,
4623 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4624 u32 cac_time_ms);
4625 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4626 struct net_device *dev);
4627 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4628 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4629 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4630 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4631 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4632 u16 duration);
4633 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4634 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4635 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4636 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4637
4638 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4639 struct net_device *dev,
4640 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4641
4642 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4643 struct net_device *dev,
4644 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4645
4646 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4647 unsigned int link_id,
4648 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4649
4650 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4651 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4652 u16 admitted_time);
4653 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4654 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4655
4656 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4657 struct net_device *dev,
4658 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4659 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4660 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4661 struct net_device *dev,
4662 const u8 *addr);
4663 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4664 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4665 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4666 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4667 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4668 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4669 u64 cookie);
4670 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4671 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4672 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4673 u32 changes);
4674
4675 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4676 struct net_device *dev,
4677 const bool enabled);
4678
4679 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4680 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4681 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4682
4683 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4684 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4685 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4686 const u8 *aa);
4687 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4688 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4689
4690 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4691 struct net_device *dev,
4692 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4693 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4694 const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4695 u64 *cookie);
4696
4697 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4698 struct net_device *dev,
4699 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4700
4701 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4702 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4703 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4704 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4705 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4706 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4707 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4709 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4710 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4711 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4712 const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4713 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4714 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4715 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4716 struct net_device *dev,
4717 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4718 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4719 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4720 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4721 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4722 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4723 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4724 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4725 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4726 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4727 struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4728
4729 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
4730 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
4731 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(3);
4732 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(4);
4733 };
4734
4735 /*
4736 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4737 * and registration/helper functions
4738 */
4739
4740 /**
4741 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4742 *
4743 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4744 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4745 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4746 * wiphy at all
4747 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4748 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4749 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4750 * reason to override the default
4751 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4752 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4753 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4754 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4755 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4756 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4757 * control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4758 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4759 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4760 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4761 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4762 * firmware.
4763 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4764 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4765 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4766 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4767 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4768 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4769 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4770 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4771 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4772 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4773 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4774 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4775 * responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4776 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4777 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4778 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4779 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4780 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4781 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4782 * before connection.
4783 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4784 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4785 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
4786 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
4787 * should set this flag for now.
4788 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
4789 */
4790 enum wiphy_flags {
4791 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0),
4792 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1),
4793 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2),
4794 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3),
4795 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4),
4796 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5),
4797 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6),
4798 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7),
4799 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8),
4800 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10),
4801 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11),
4802 /* use hole at 12 */
4803 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13),
4804 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14),
4805 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15),
4806 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16),
4807 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17),
4808 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18),
4809 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19),
4810 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20),
4811 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21),
4812 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22),
4813 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23),
4814 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP = BIT(24),
4815 };
4816
4817 /**
4818 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4819 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4820 * @types: interface types (bits)
4821 */
4822 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4823 u16 max;
4824 u16 types;
4825 };
4826
4827 /**
4828 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4829 *
4830 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4831 * combinations it supports concurrently.
4832 *
4833 * Examples:
4834 *
4835 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4836 *
4837 * .. code-block:: c
4838 *
4839 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4840 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4841 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4842 * };
4843 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4844 * .limits = limits1,
4845 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4846 * .max_interfaces = 2,
4847 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4848 * };
4849 *
4850 *
4851 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4852 *
4853 * .. code-block:: c
4854 *
4855 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4856 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4857 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4858 * };
4859 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4860 * .limits = limits2,
4861 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4862 * .max_interfaces = 8,
4863 * .num_different_channels = 1,
4864 * };
4865 *
4866 *
4867 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4868 *
4869 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4870 *
4871 * .. code-block:: c
4872 *
4873 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4874 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4875 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4876 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4877 * };
4878 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4879 * .limits = limits3,
4880 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4881 * .max_interfaces = 4,
4882 * .num_different_channels = 2,
4883 * };
4884 *
4885 */
4886 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4887 /**
4888 * @limits:
4889 * limits for the given interface types
4890 */
4891 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4892
4893 /**
4894 * @num_different_channels:
4895 * can use up to this many different channels
4896 */
4897 u32 num_different_channels;
4898
4899 /**
4900 * @max_interfaces:
4901 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4902 */
4903 u16 max_interfaces;
4904
4905 /**
4906 * @n_limits:
4907 * number of limitations
4908 */
4909 u8 n_limits;
4910
4911 /**
4912 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4913 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4914 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4915 */
4916 bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4917
4918 /**
4919 * @radar_detect_widths:
4920 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4921 */
4922 u8 radar_detect_widths;
4923
4924 /**
4925 * @radar_detect_regions:
4926 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4927 */
4928 u8 radar_detect_regions;
4929
4930 /**
4931 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4932 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4933 *
4934 * = 0
4935 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4936 * > 0
4937 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4938 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4939 * combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4940 */
4941 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4942 };
4943
4944 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4945 u16 tx, rx;
4946 };
4947
4948 /**
4949 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4950 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4951 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4952 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4953 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4954 * packet should be preserved in that case
4955 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4956 * (see nl80211.h)
4957 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4958 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4959 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4960 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4961 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4962 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4963 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4964 */
4965 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4966 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0),
4967 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1),
4968 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2),
4969 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3),
4970 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4),
4971 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5),
4972 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6),
4973 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7),
4974 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8),
4975 };
4976
4977 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4978 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4979 u32 data_payload_max;
4980 u32 data_interval_max;
4981 u32 wake_payload_max;
4982 bool seq;
4983 };
4984
4985 /**
4986 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4987 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4988 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4989 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4990 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4991 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4992 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4993 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4994 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4995 * scheduled scans.
4996 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4997 * details.
4998 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4999 */
5000 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5001 u32 flags;
5002 int n_patterns;
5003 int pattern_max_len;
5004 int pattern_min_len;
5005 int max_pkt_offset;
5006 int max_nd_match_sets;
5007 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5008 };
5009
5010 /**
5011 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5012 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5013 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5014 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5015 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5016 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5017 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5018 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5019 */
5020 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5021 int n_rules;
5022 int max_delay;
5023 int n_patterns;
5024 int pattern_max_len;
5025 int pattern_min_len;
5026 int max_pkt_offset;
5027 };
5028
5029 /**
5030 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5031 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5032 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5033 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5034 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5035 */
5036 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5037 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5038 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5039 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5040 };
5041
5042 /**
5043 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5044 *
5045 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5046 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5047 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5048 *
5049 */
5050 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5051 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
5052 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1),
5053 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2),
5054 };
5055
5056 /**
5057 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5058 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5059 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5060 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5061 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5062 */
5063
5064 struct sta_opmode_info {
5065 u32 changed;
5066 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5067 enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5068 u8 rx_nss;
5069 };
5070
5071 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5072
5073 /**
5074 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5075 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5076 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5077 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5078 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5079 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5080 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5081 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5082 * dumpit calls.
5083 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5084 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5085 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5086 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5087 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5088 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5089 * are used with dump requests.
5090 */
5091 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5092 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5093 u32 flags;
5094 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5095 const void *data, int data_len);
5096 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5097 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5098 unsigned long *storage);
5099 const struct nla_policy *policy;
5100 unsigned int maxattr;
5101
5102 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5103 };
5104
5105 /**
5106 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5107 * @iftype: interface type
5108 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5109 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5110 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5111 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5112 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5113 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5114 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5115 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5116 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5117 */
5118 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5119 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5120 const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5121 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5122 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5123 u16 eml_capabilities;
5124 u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5125 };
5126
5127 /**
5128 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5129 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5130 * @type: the interface type to look up
5131 */
5132 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5133 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5134
5135 /**
5136 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5137 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5138 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5139 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5140 * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5141 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5142 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5143 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5144 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5145 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5146 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5147 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5148 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5149 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5150 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5151 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5152 * not limited)
5153 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5154 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5155 */
5156 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5157 unsigned int max_peers;
5158 u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5159 randomize_mac_addr:1;
5160
5161 struct {
5162 u32 preambles;
5163 u32 bandwidths;
5164 s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5165 u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5166 u8 supported:1,
5167 asap:1,
5168 non_asap:1,
5169 request_lci:1,
5170 request_civicloc:1,
5171 trigger_based:1,
5172 non_trigger_based:1;
5173 } ftm;
5174 };
5175
5176 /**
5177 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5178 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5179 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5180 *
5181 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5182 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5183 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5184 */
5185 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5186 u16 iftypes_mask;
5187 const u32 *akm_suites;
5188 int n_akm_suites;
5189 };
5190
5191 /**
5192 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5193 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5194 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5195 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5196 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5197 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5198 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5199 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5200 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5201 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5202 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5203 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5204 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5205 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5206 * iftype_akm_suites.
5207 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5208 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5209 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5210 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5211 * instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5212 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5213 * suites are specified separately.
5214 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5215 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5216 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5217 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5218 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5219 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5220 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5221 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5222 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5223 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5224 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5225 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5226 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5227 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5228 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5229 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5230 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5231 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5232 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5233 * unregister hardware
5234 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5235 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5236 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5237 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5238 * (see below).
5239 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5240 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5241 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5242 * must be set by driver
5243 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5244 * list single interface types.
5245 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5246 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5247 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5248 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5249 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5250 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5251 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5252 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5253 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5254 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5255 * this variable determines its size
5256 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5257 * any given scan
5258 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5259 * the device can run concurrently.
5260 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5261 * for in any given scheduled scan
5262 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5263 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5264 * supported.
5265 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5266 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5267 * include fixed IEs like supported rates
5268 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5269 * scans
5270 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5271 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5272 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5273 * single scan plan supported by the device.
5274 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5275 * scan plan supported by the device.
5276 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5277 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5278 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5279 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5280 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5281 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5282 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5283 *
5284 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5285 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5286 * type
5287 *
5288 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5289 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5290 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5291 *
5292 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5293 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5294 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5295 *
5296 * @probe_resp_offload:
5297 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5298 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5299 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5300 *
5301 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5302 * may request, if implemented.
5303 *
5304 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5305 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5306 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5307 * to the suspend() operation instead.
5308 *
5309 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5310 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5311 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5312 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5313 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5314 *
5315 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5316 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5317 *
5318 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5319 * supports for ACL.
5320 *
5321 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5322 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5323 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5324 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5325 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5326 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5327 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5328 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5329 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5330 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5331 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5332 * capabilities are specified separately.
5333 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5334 *
5335 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5336 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5337 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5338 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5339 *
5340 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5341 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5342 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5343 * some cases, but may not always reach.
5344 *
5345 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5346 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver
5347 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5348 * infinite.
5349 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5350 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5351 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5352 *
5353 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5354 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for
5355 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5356 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5357 *
5358 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5359 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5360 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5361 *
5362 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5363 * wake_tx_queue
5364 *
5365 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5366 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5367 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5368 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5369 *
5370 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5371 *
5372 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5373 * device has
5374 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5375 * supported by the driver for each vif
5376 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5377 * supported by the driver for each peer
5378 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5379 * long/short retry configuration
5380 *
5381 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5382 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5383 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5384 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5385 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5386 *
5387 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5388 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5389 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5390 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5391 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5392 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5393 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5394 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5395 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5396 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5397 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5398 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5399 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5400 */
5401 struct wiphy {
5402 struct mutex mtx;
5403
5404 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5405
5406 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5407 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5408
5409 struct mac_address *addresses;
5410
5411 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5412
5413 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5414 int n_iface_combinations;
5415 u16 software_iftypes;
5416
5417 u16 n_addresses;
5418
5419 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5420 u16 interface_modes;
5421
5422 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5423
5424 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5425 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5426
5427 u32 ap_sme_capa;
5428
5429 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5430
5431 int bss_priv_size;
5432 u8 max_scan_ssids;
5433 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5434 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5435 u8 max_match_sets;
5436 u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5437 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5438 u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5439 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5440 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5441
5442 int n_cipher_suites;
5443 const u32 *cipher_suites;
5444
5445 int n_akm_suites;
5446 const u32 *akm_suites;
5447
5448 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5449 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5450
5451 u8 retry_short;
5452 u8 retry_long;
5453 u32 frag_threshold;
5454 u32 rts_threshold;
5455 u8 coverage_class;
5456
5457 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5458 u32 hw_version;
5459
5460 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5461 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5462 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5463 #endif
5464
5465 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5466
5467 u8 max_num_pmkids;
5468
5469 u32 available_antennas_tx;
5470 u32 available_antennas_rx;
5471
5472 u32 probe_resp_offload;
5473
5474 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5475 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5476
5477 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5478 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5479
5480 const void *privid;
5481
5482 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5483
5484 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5485 struct regulatory_request *request);
5486
5487 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5488
5489 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5490
5491 struct device dev;
5492
5493 bool registered;
5494
5495 struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5496
5497 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5498 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5499
5500 struct list_head wdev_list;
5501
5502 possible_net_t _net;
5503
5504 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5505 const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5506 #endif
5507
5508 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5509
5510 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5511 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5512 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5513
5514 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5515
5516 u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5517
5518 u32 bss_select_support;
5519
5520 u8 nan_supported_bands;
5521
5522 u32 txq_limit;
5523 u32 txq_memory_limit;
5524 u32 txq_quantum;
5525
5526 unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5527
5528 u8 support_mbssid:1,
5529 support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5530
5531 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5532
5533 struct {
5534 u64 peer, vif;
5535 u8 max_retry;
5536 } tid_config_support;
5537
5538 u8 max_data_retry_count;
5539
5540 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5541
5542 struct rfkill *rfkill;
5543
5544 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5545 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5546 u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5547
5548 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
5549
5550 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5551 };
5552
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5553 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5554 {
5555 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5556 }
5557
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5558 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5559 {
5560 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5561 }
5562
5563 /**
5564 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5565 *
5566 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5567 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5568 */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5569 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5570 {
5571 BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5572 return &wiphy->priv;
5573 }
5574
5575 /**
5576 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5577 *
5578 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5579 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5580 */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5581 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5582 {
5583 BUG_ON(!priv);
5584 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5585 }
5586
5587 /**
5588 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5589 *
5590 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5591 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5592 */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5593 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5594 {
5595 wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5596 }
5597
5598 /**
5599 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5600 *
5601 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5602 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5603 */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5604 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5605 {
5606 return wiphy->dev.parent;
5607 }
5608
5609 /**
5610 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5611 *
5612 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5613 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5614 */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5615 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5616 {
5617 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5618 }
5619
5620 /**
5621 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5622 *
5623 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5624 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5625 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5626 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5627 *
5628 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5629 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5630 *
5631 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5632 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5633 */
5634 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5635 const char *requested_name);
5636
5637 /**
5638 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5639 *
5640 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5641 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5642 *
5643 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5644 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5645 *
5646 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5647 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5648 */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5649 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5650 int sizeof_priv)
5651 {
5652 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5653 }
5654
5655 /**
5656 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5657 *
5658 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5659 *
5660 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5661 */
5662 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5663
5664 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5665 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5666
5667 /**
5668 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5669 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5670 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5671 *
5672 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5673 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5674 */
5675 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \
5676 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5677
5678 /**
5679 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5680 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5681 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5682 *
5683 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5684 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5685 */
5686 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \
5687 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5688
5689 /**
5690 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5691 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5692 */
5693 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5694
5695 /**
5696 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5697 *
5698 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5699 *
5700 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5701 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5702 * request that is being handled.
5703 */
5704 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5705
5706 /**
5707 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5708 *
5709 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5710 */
5711 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5712
5713 /* internal structs */
5714 struct cfg80211_conn;
5715 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5716 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5717 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5718
5719 /**
5720 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5721 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5722 *
5723 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
5724 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
5725 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
5726 * differentiate which way it's called.
5727 *
5728 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
5729 *
5730 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5731 *
5732 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
5733 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
5734 */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5735 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5736 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5737 {
5738 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5739 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5740 }
5741
5742 /**
5743 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5744 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5745 */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)5746 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5747 __releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5748 {
5749 __release(&wiphy->mtx);
5750 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5751 }
5752
5753 struct wiphy_work;
5754 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
5755
5756 struct wiphy_work {
5757 struct list_head entry;
5758 wiphy_work_func_t func;
5759 };
5760
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)5761 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
5762 wiphy_work_func_t func)
5763 {
5764 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
5765 work->func = func;
5766 }
5767
5768 /**
5769 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
5770 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5771 * @work: the work item
5772 *
5773 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5774 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5775 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5776 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5777 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5778 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5779 */
5780 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5781
5782 /**
5783 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
5784 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5785 * @work: the work to cancel
5786 *
5787 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5788 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5789 */
5790 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5791
5792 /**
5793 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
5794 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5795 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
5796 *
5797 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5798 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5799 */
5800 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
5801
5802 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
5803 struct wiphy_work work;
5804 struct wiphy *wiphy;
5805 struct timer_list timer;
5806 };
5807
5808 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
5809
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)5810 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5811 wiphy_work_func_t func)
5812 {
5813 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
5814 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
5815 }
5816
5817 /**
5818 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
5819 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
5820 * @dwork: the delayable worker
5821 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5822 *
5823 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
5824 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
5825 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
5826 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
5827 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
5828 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
5829 */
5830 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5831 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
5832 unsigned long delay);
5833
5834 /**
5835 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
5836 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5837 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
5838 *
5839 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
5840 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5841 */
5842 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5843 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5844
5845 /**
5846 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
5847 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
5848 * @work: the work to flush
5849 *
5850 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
5851 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
5852 */
5853 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5854 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
5855
5856 /**
5857 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5858 *
5859 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5860 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5861 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5862 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5863 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5864 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
5865 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
5866 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
5867 *
5868 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5869 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5870 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5871 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5872 *
5873 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5874 * @iftype: interface type
5875 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
5876 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
5877 * for the notifier
5878 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5879 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5880 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5881 * wireless device if it has no netdev
5882 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
5883 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
5884 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5885 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5886 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5887 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5888 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5889 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5890 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5891 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5892 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5893 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5894 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5895 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5896 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5897 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5898 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5899 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5900 * by cfg80211 on change_interface
5901 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5902 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5903 * need to propagate the update to the driver
5904 * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5905 * and some API functions require it held
5906 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5907 * beacons, 0 when not valid
5908 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5909 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5910 * the P2P Device.
5911 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5912 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5913 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5914 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5915 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5916 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5917 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5918 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5919 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5920 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5921 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5922 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5923 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5924 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5925 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5926 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5927 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5928 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
5929 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5930 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5931 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5932 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5933 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5934 * unprotected beacon report
5935 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
5936 * @ap and @client for each link
5937 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
5938 */
5939 struct wireless_dev {
5940 struct wiphy *wiphy;
5941 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5942
5943 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5944 struct list_head list;
5945 struct net_device *netdev;
5946
5947 u32 identifier;
5948
5949 struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5950 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5951
5952 struct mutex mtx;
5953
5954 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
5955
5956 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5957
5958 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5959 struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5960 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5961 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5962 u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5963
5964 struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5965 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5966
5967 struct list_head event_list;
5968 spinlock_t event_lock;
5969
5970 u8 connected:1;
5971
5972 bool ps;
5973 int ps_timeout;
5974
5975 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5976
5977 u32 owner_nlportid;
5978 bool nl_owner_dead;
5979
5980 /* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */
5981 bool cac_started;
5982 unsigned long cac_start_time;
5983 unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5984
5985 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5986 /* wext data */
5987 struct {
5988 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5989 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5990 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5991 const u8 *ie;
5992 size_t ie_len;
5993 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5994 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5995 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5996 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5997 bool prev_bssid_valid;
5998 } wext;
5999 #endif
6000
6001 struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
6002
6003 struct list_head pmsr_list;
6004 spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6005 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6006
6007 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6008
6009 union {
6010 struct {
6011 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6012 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6013 u8 ssid_len;
6014 } client;
6015 struct {
6016 int beacon_interval;
6017 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6018 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6019 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6020 u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6021 } mesh;
6022 struct {
6023 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6024 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6025 u8 ssid_len;
6026 } ap;
6027 struct {
6028 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6029 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6030 int beacon_interval;
6031 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6032 u8 ssid_len;
6033 } ibss;
6034 struct {
6035 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6036 } ocb;
6037 } u;
6038
6039 struct {
6040 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6041 union {
6042 struct {
6043 unsigned int beacon_interval;
6044 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6045 } ap;
6046 struct {
6047 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6048 } client;
6049 };
6050 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6051 u16 valid_links;
6052
6053 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(1);
6054 ANDROID_KABI_RESERVE(2);
6055 };
6056
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6057 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6058 {
6059 if (wdev->netdev)
6060 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6061 return wdev->address;
6062 }
6063
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6064 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6065 {
6066 if (wdev->netdev)
6067 return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6068 return wdev->is_running;
6069 }
6070
6071 /**
6072 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6073 *
6074 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6075 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6076 */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6077 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6078 {
6079 BUG_ON(!wdev);
6080 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6081 }
6082
6083 /**
6084 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6085 * @wdev: the wdev
6086 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6087 *
6088 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6089 */
6090 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6091 unsigned int link_id);
6092
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6093 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6094 unsigned int link_id)
6095 {
6096 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6097 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6098 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6099 }
6100
6101 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \
6102 for (link_id = 0; \
6103 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \
6104 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \
6105 link_id++) \
6106 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \
6107 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6108
6109 /**
6110 * DOC: Utility functions
6111 *
6112 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6113 */
6114
6115 /**
6116 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6117 *
6118 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6119 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6120 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6121 */
6122 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6123 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6124 struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6125 {
6126 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6127 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6128 }
6129
6130 /**
6131 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6132 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6133 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6134 */
6135 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6136 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6137 {
6138 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6139 }
6140
6141 /**
6142 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6143 *
6144 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6145 * @chan: channel
6146 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6147 */
6148 enum nl80211_chan_width
6149 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6150
6151 /**
6152 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6153 * @chan: channel number
6154 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6155 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6156 */
6157 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6158
6159 /**
6160 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6161 * @chan: channel number
6162 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6163 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6164 */
6165 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6166 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6167 {
6168 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6169 }
6170
6171 /**
6172 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6173 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6174 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6175 */
6176 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6177
6178 /**
6179 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6180 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6181 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6182 */
6183 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6184 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6185 {
6186 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6187 }
6188
6189 /**
6190 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6191 * frequency
6192 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6193 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6194 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6195 */
6196 struct ieee80211_channel *
6197 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6198
6199 /**
6200 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6201 *
6202 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6203 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6204 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6205 */
6206 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6207 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6208 {
6209 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6210 }
6211
6212 /**
6213 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6214 * @chan: control channel to check
6215 *
6216 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6217 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6218 */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6219 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6220 {
6221 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6222 return false;
6223
6224 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6225 }
6226
6227 /**
6228 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6229 *
6230 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6231 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6232 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6233 *
6234 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6235 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6236 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6237 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6238 */
6239 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6240 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6241 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6242
6243 /**
6244 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6245 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6246 * @scan_width: width of the control channel
6247 *
6248 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
6249 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6250 */
6251 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6252 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
6253
6254 /*
6255 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6256 *
6257 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6258 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6259 */
6260
6261 struct radiotap_align_size {
6262 uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6263 };
6264
6265 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6266 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6267 int n_bits;
6268 uint32_t oui;
6269 uint8_t subns;
6270 };
6271
6272 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6273 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6274 int n_ns;
6275 };
6276
6277 /**
6278 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6279 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6280 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6281 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6282 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6283 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6284 * the beginning of the actual data portion
6285 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6286 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6287 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6288 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6289 * radiotap namespace or not
6290 *
6291 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6292 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6293 * @_arg_index: next argument index
6294 * @_arg: next argument pointer
6295 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6296 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6297 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6298 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6299 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6300 * next bitmap word
6301 *
6302 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6303 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6304 */
6305
6306 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6307 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6308 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6309 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6310
6311 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6312 __le32 *_next_bitmap;
6313
6314 unsigned char *this_arg;
6315 int this_arg_index;
6316 int this_arg_size;
6317
6318 int is_radiotap_ns;
6319
6320 int _max_length;
6321 int _arg_index;
6322 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6323 int _reset_on_ext;
6324 };
6325
6326 int
6327 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6328 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6329 int max_length,
6330 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6331
6332 int
6333 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6334
6335
6336 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6337 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6338
6339 /**
6340 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6341 *
6342 * @skb: the frame
6343 *
6344 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6345 * returns the 802.11 header length.
6346 *
6347 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6348 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6349 * 802.11 header.
6350 */
6351 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6352
6353 /**
6354 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6355 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6356 * Return: The header length in bytes.
6357 */
6358 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6359
6360 /**
6361 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6362 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6363 * (first byte) will be accessed
6364 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6365 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6366 */
6367 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6368
6369 /**
6370 * DOC: Data path helpers
6371 *
6372 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6373 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6374 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6375 */
6376
6377 /**
6378 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6379 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6380 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6381 * of it being pushed into the SKB
6382 * @addr: the device MAC address
6383 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6384 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6385 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6386 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6387 */
6388 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6389 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6390 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6391
6392 /**
6393 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6394 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6395 * @addr: the device MAC address
6396 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6397 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6398 */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6399 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6400 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6401 {
6402 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6403 }
6404
6405 /**
6406 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6407 *
6408 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6409 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6410 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6411 *
6412 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6413 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6414 * initialized by the caller.
6415 * @addr: The device MAC address.
6416 * @iftype: The device interface type.
6417 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6418 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6419 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6420 */
6421 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6422 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6423 const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6424 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
6425
6426 /**
6427 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6428 * @skb: the data frame
6429 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6430 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6431 */
6432 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6433 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6434
6435 /**
6436 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6437 *
6438 * @eid: element ID
6439 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6440 * @len: length of data
6441 * @match: byte array to match
6442 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6443 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6444 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6445 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6446 * the data portion instead.
6447 *
6448 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6449 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6450 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6451 * requested element struct.
6452 *
6453 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6454 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6455 * byte array to match.
6456 */
6457 const struct element *
6458 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6459 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6460 unsigned int match_offset);
6461
6462 /**
6463 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6464 *
6465 * @eid: element ID
6466 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6467 * @len: length of data
6468 * @match: byte array to match
6469 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6470 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6471 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6472 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6473 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6474 * the second byte is the IE length.
6475 *
6476 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6477 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6478 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6479 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6480 * element ID.
6481 *
6482 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6483 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6484 * byte array to match.
6485 */
6486 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6487 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6488 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6489 unsigned int match_offset)
6490 {
6491 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6492 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6493 */
6494 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6495 (!match_len && match_offset)))
6496 return NULL;
6497
6498 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6499 match, match_len,
6500 match_offset ?
6501 match_offset - 2 : 0);
6502 }
6503
6504 /**
6505 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6506 *
6507 * @eid: element ID
6508 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6509 * @len: length of data
6510 *
6511 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6512 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6513 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6514 * requested element struct.
6515 *
6516 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6517 * having to fit into the given data.
6518 */
6519 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6520 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6521 {
6522 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6523 }
6524
6525 /**
6526 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6527 *
6528 * @eid: element ID
6529 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6530 * @len: length of data
6531 *
6532 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6533 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6534 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6535 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6536 *
6537 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6538 * having to fit into the given data.
6539 */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6540 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6541 {
6542 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6543 }
6544
6545 /**
6546 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6547 *
6548 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6549 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6550 * @len: length of data
6551 *
6552 * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
6553 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6554 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6555 * requested element struct.
6556 *
6557 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6558 * having to fit into the given data.
6559 */
6560 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6561 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6562 {
6563 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6564 &ext_eid, 1, 0);
6565 }
6566
6567 /**
6568 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6569 *
6570 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6571 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6572 * @len: length of data
6573 *
6574 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6575 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6576 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6577 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6578 *
6579 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6580 * having to fit into the given data.
6581 */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6582 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6583 {
6584 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6585 &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6586 }
6587
6588 /**
6589 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6590 *
6591 * @oui: vendor OUI
6592 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6593 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6594 * @len: length of data
6595 *
6596 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6597 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6598 * return the element structure for the requested element.
6599 *
6600 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6601 * the given data.
6602 */
6603 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6604 const u8 *ies,
6605 unsigned int len);
6606
6607 /**
6608 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6609 *
6610 * @oui: vendor OUI
6611 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6612 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6613 * @len: length of data
6614 *
6615 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6616 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6617 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6618 * element ID.
6619 *
6620 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6621 * the given data.
6622 */
6623 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)6624 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6625 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6626 {
6627 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6628 }
6629
6630 /**
6631 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6632 *
6633 * @dev: network device
6634 * @addr: STA MAC address
6635 *
6636 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6637 * devices upon STA association.
6638 */
6639 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6640
6641 /**
6642 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6643 *
6644 * TODO
6645 */
6646
6647 /**
6648 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6649 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6650 * conflicts)
6651 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6652 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6653 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6654 * alpha2.
6655 *
6656 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6657 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6658 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6659 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6660 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6661 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6662 *
6663 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6664 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6665 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6666 *
6667 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6668 * an -ENOMEM.
6669 *
6670 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6671 */
6672 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6673
6674 /**
6675 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6676 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6677 * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
6678 *
6679 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6680 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6681 * information.
6682 *
6683 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6684 */
6685 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6686 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6687
6688 /**
6689 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6690 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6691 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6692 *
6693 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6694 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6695 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6696 *
6697 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6698 */
6699 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6700 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6701
6702 /**
6703 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6704 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6705 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6706 *
6707 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6708 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6709 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6710 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6711 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6712 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6713 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6714 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6715 * that called this helper.
6716 */
6717 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6718 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6719
6720 /**
6721 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6722 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6723 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6724 *
6725 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6726 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6727 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6728 * and processed already.
6729 *
6730 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6731 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6732 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6733 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6734 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6735 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6736 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6737 */
6738 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6739 u32 center_freq);
6740
6741 /**
6742 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6743 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6744 *
6745 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6746 * proper string representation.
6747 */
6748 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6749
6750 /**
6751 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6752 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6753 *
6754 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6755 */
6756 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6757
6758 /**
6759 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6760 *
6761 */
6762
6763 /**
6764 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6765 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6766 *
6767 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6768 * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6769 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6770 *
6771 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query
6772 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6773 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6774 *
6775 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6776 * an -ENODATA.
6777 *
6778 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6779 */
6780 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6781 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6782
6783 /*
6784 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6785 * functions and BSS handling helpers
6786 */
6787
6788 /**
6789 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6790 *
6791 * @request: the corresponding scan request
6792 * @info: information about the completed scan
6793 */
6794 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6795 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6796
6797 /**
6798 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6799 *
6800 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6801 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6802 */
6803 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6804
6805 /**
6806 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6807 *
6808 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6809 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6810 *
6811 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6812 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
6813 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6814 */
6815 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6816
6817 /**
6818 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6819 *
6820 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6821 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6822 *
6823 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6824 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
6825 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6826 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6827 */
6828 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6829
6830 /**
6831 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6832 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6833 * @data: the BSS metadata
6834 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6835 * @len: length of the management frame
6836 * @gfp: context flags
6837 *
6838 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6839 * the BSS should be updated/added.
6840 *
6841 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6842 * Or %NULL on error.
6843 */
6844 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6845 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6846 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6847 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6848 gfp_t gfp);
6849
6850 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6851 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6852 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6853 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6854 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6855 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6856 {
6857 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6858 .chan = rx_channel,
6859 .scan_width = scan_width,
6860 .signal = signal,
6861 };
6862
6863 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6864 }
6865
6866 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6867 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6868 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6869 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6870 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6871 {
6872 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6873 .chan = rx_channel,
6874 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6875 .signal = signal,
6876 };
6877
6878 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6879 }
6880
6881 /**
6882 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6883 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6884 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6885 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6886 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6887 */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)6888 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6889 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6890 {
6891 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6892 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6893 u64 new_bssid_u64;
6894
6895 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6896
6897 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6898
6899 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6900 }
6901
6902 /**
6903 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6904 * @element: element to check
6905 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6906 */
6907 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6908 const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6909
6910 /**
6911 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6912 * @ie: ies
6913 * @ielen: length of IEs
6914 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6915 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6916 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6917 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6918 */
6919 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6920 const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6921 const struct element *sub_elem,
6922 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6923
6924 /**
6925 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6926 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6927 * from a beacon or probe response
6928 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6929 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6930 */
6931 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6932 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6933 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6934 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6935 };
6936
6937 /**
6938 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
6939 * @ie: IEs
6940 * @ielen: length of IEs
6941 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
6942 * @ftype: frame type
6943 *
6944 * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
6945 */
6946 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6947 enum nl80211_band band,
6948 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype);
6949
6950 /**
6951 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6952 *
6953 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6954 * @data: the BSS metadata
6955 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6956 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6957 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6958 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6959 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6960 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6961 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6962 * @gfp: context flags
6963 *
6964 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6965 * the BSS should be updated/added.
6966 *
6967 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6968 * Or %NULL on error.
6969 */
6970 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6971 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6972 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6973 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6974 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6975 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6976 gfp_t gfp);
6977
6978 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6979 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6980 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6981 enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6982 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6983 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6984 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6985 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6986 {
6987 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6988 .chan = rx_channel,
6989 .scan_width = scan_width,
6990 .signal = signal,
6991 };
6992
6993 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6994 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6995 gfp);
6996 }
6997
6998 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)6999 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7000 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7001 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7002 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7003 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7004 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7005 {
7006 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7007 .chan = rx_channel,
7008 .scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
7009 .signal = signal,
7010 };
7011
7012 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7013 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7014 gfp);
7015 }
7016
7017 /**
7018 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7019 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7020 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7021 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7022 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7023 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7024 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7025 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7026 */
7027 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7028 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7029 const u8 *bssid,
7030 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7031 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7032 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
7033 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7034 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7035 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7036 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7037 {
7038 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7039 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7040 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7041 }
7042
7043 /**
7044 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7045 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7046 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7047 *
7048 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7049 */
7050 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7051
7052 /**
7053 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7054 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7055 * @bss: the BSS struct
7056 *
7057 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7058 */
7059 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7060
7061 /**
7062 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7063 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7064 * @bss: the bss to remove
7065 *
7066 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7067 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7068 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7069 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7070 */
7071 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7072
7073 /**
7074 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7075 *
7076 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7077 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7078 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7079 *
7080 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7081 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7082 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7083 * @iter: the iterator function to call
7084 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7085 */
7086 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7087 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7088 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7089 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7090 void *data),
7091 void *iter_data);
7092
7093 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)7094 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7095 {
7096 switch (chandef->width) {
7097 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
7098 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
7099 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
7100 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
7101 default:
7102 return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7103 }
7104 }
7105
7106 /**
7107 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7108 * @dev: network device
7109 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7110 * @len: length of the frame data
7111 *
7112 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7113 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7114 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7115 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7116 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7117 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7118 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7119 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7120 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7121 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7122 *
7123 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7124 */
7125 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7126
7127 /**
7128 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7129 * @dev: network device
7130 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7131 *
7132 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7133 * mutex.
7134 */
7135 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7136
7137 /**
7138 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - association response data
7139 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
7140 * moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7141 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7142 * @len: length of the frame data
7143 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7144 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7145 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7146 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7147 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7148 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7149 * non-MLO connections
7150 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7151 * were rejected by the AP.
7152 */
7153 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp {
7154 const u8 *buf;
7155 size_t len;
7156 const u8 *req_ies;
7157 size_t req_ies_len;
7158 int uapsd_queues;
7159 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7160 struct {
7161 const u8 *addr;
7162 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7163 u16 status;
7164 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7165 };
7166
7167 /**
7168 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7169 * @dev: network device
7170 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp
7171 *
7172 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7173 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7174 *
7175 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7176 */
7177 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7178 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp *data);
7179
7180 /**
7181 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7182 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7183 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7184 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7185 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7186 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7187 * other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7188 */
7189 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7190 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7191 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7192 bool timeout;
7193 };
7194
7195 /**
7196 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7197 * @dev: network device
7198 * @data: data describing the association failure
7199 *
7200 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7201 */
7202 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7203 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7204
7205 /**
7206 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7207 * @dev: network device
7208 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7209 * @len: length of the frame data
7210 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7211 *
7212 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7213 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7214 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7215 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7216 */
7217 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7218 bool reconnect);
7219
7220 /**
7221 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7222 * @dev: network device
7223 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7224 * @len: length of the frame data
7225 *
7226 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7227 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7228 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7229 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7230 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7231 *
7232 * This function may sleep.
7233 */
7234 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7235 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7236
7237 /**
7238 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7239 * @dev: network device
7240 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7241 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7242 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7243 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7244 * @gfp: allocation flags
7245 *
7246 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7247 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7248 * primitive.
7249 */
7250 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7251 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7252 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7253
7254 /**
7255 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7256 *
7257 * @dev: network device
7258 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7259 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7260 * @gfp: allocation flags
7261 *
7262 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7263 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7264 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7265 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7266 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7267 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7268 */
7269 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7270 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7271
7272 /**
7273 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7274 * candidate
7275 *
7276 * @dev: network device
7277 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7278 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7279 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7280 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7281 * @gfp: allocation flags
7282 *
7283 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7284 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7285 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7286 */
7287 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7288 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7289 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7290
7291 /**
7292 * DOC: RFkill integration
7293 *
7294 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7295 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7296 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7297 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
7298 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7299 *
7300 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7301 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7302 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7303 */
7304
7305 /**
7306 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7307 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7308 * @blocked: block status
7309 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7310 */
7311 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7312 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7313
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7314 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7315 {
7316 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7317 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7318 }
7319
7320 /**
7321 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7322 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7323 */
7324 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7325
7326 /**
7327 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7328 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7329 */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7330 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7331 {
7332 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7333 }
7334
7335 /**
7336 * DOC: Vendor commands
7337 *
7338 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7339 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7340 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7341 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7342 * the configuration mechanism.
7343 *
7344 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7345 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
7346 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7347 *
7348 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7349 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7350 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7351 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7352 * managers etc. need.
7353 */
7354
7355 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7356 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7357 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7358 int approxlen);
7359
7360 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7361 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7362 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7363 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7364 unsigned int portid,
7365 int vendor_event_idx,
7366 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7367
7368 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7369
7370 /**
7371 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7372 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7373 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7374 * be put into the skb
7375 *
7376 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7377 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7378 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7379 *
7380 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7381 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7382 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7383 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7384 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7385 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7386 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7387 *
7388 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7389 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7390 *
7391 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7392 */
7393 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7394 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7395 {
7396 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7397 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7398 }
7399
7400 /**
7401 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7402 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7403 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7404 *
7405 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7406 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7407 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the
7408 * skb regardless of the return value.
7409 *
7410 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7411 */
7412 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7413
7414 /**
7415 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7416 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7417 *
7418 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7419 * Valid to call only there.
7420 */
7421 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7422
7423 /**
7424 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7425 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7426 * @wdev: the wireless device
7427 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7428 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7429 * be put into the skb
7430 * @gfp: allocation flags
7431 *
7432 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7433 * vendor-specific multicast group.
7434 *
7435 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7436 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7437 * attribute.
7438 *
7439 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7440 * skb to send the event.
7441 *
7442 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7443 */
7444 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7445 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7446 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7447 {
7448 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7449 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7450 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7451 }
7452
7453 /**
7454 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7455 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7456 * @wdev: the wireless device
7457 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7458 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7459 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7460 * be put into the skb
7461 * @gfp: allocation flags
7462 *
7463 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7464 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7465 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7466 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7467 *
7468 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7469 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7470 * attribute.
7471 *
7472 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7473 * skb to send the event.
7474 *
7475 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7476 */
7477 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7478 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7479 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7480 unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7481 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7482 {
7483 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7484 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7485 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7486 }
7487
7488 /**
7489 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7490 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7491 * @gfp: allocation flags
7492 *
7493 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7494 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7495 */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7496 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7497 {
7498 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7499 }
7500
7501 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7502 /**
7503 * DOC: Test mode
7504 *
7505 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7506 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7507 * factory programming.
7508 *
7509 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
7510 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7511 */
7512
7513 /**
7514 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7515 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7516 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7517 * be put into the skb
7518 *
7519 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7520 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7521 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7522 *
7523 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7524 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7525 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7526 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7527 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7528 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7529 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7530 *
7531 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7532 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7533 *
7534 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7535 */
7536 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7537 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7538 {
7539 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7540 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7541 }
7542
7543 /**
7544 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7545 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7546 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7547 *
7548 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7549 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7550 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb
7551 * regardless of the return value.
7552 *
7553 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7554 */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)7555 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7556 {
7557 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7558 }
7559
7560 /**
7561 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
7562 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7563 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7564 * be put into the skb
7565 * @gfp: allocation flags
7566 *
7567 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7568 * testmode multicast group.
7569 *
7570 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
7571 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
7572 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
7573 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
7574 * in any other way.
7575 *
7576 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
7577 * skb to send the event.
7578 *
7579 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7580 */
7581 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)7582 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
7583 {
7584 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7585 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
7586 approxlen, gfp);
7587 }
7588
7589 /**
7590 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
7591 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7592 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
7593 * @gfp: allocation flags
7594 *
7595 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7596 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
7597 * consumes it.
7598 */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7599 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7600 {
7601 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7602 }
7603
7604 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd),
7605 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd),
7606 #else
7607 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
7608 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
7609 #endif
7610
7611 /**
7612 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
7613 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
7614 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
7615 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
7616 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid.
7617 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
7618 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
7619 * status for a FILS connection.
7620 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7621 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
7622 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
7623 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
7624 */
7625 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
7626 const u8 *kek;
7627 size_t kek_len;
7628 bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
7629 u16 erp_next_seq_num;
7630 const u8 *pmk;
7631 size_t pmk_len;
7632 const u8 *pmkid;
7633 };
7634
7635 /**
7636 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
7637 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7638 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7639 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7640 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7641 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7642 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7643 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7644 * case.
7645 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
7646 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7647 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7648 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7649 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7650 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7651 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7652 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7653 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7654 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7655 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7656 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
7657 * zero.
7658 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7659 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
7660 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
7661 * connected AP info.
7662 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
7663 * %NULL.
7664 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
7665 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
7666 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
7667 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
7668 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
7669 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
7670 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
7671 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
7672 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
7673 * to be specified.
7674 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
7675 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
7676 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
7677 */
7678 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7679 int status;
7680 const u8 *req_ie;
7681 size_t req_ie_len;
7682 const u8 *resp_ie;
7683 size_t resp_ie_len;
7684 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7685 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7686
7687 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7688 u16 valid_links;
7689 struct {
7690 const u8 *addr;
7691 const u8 *bssid;
7692 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7693 u16 status;
7694 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7695 };
7696
7697 /**
7698 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7699 *
7700 * @dev: network device
7701 * @params: connection response parameters
7702 * @gfp: allocation flags
7703 *
7704 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7705 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7706 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7707 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7708 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7709 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7710 */
7711 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7712 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7713 gfp_t gfp);
7714
7715 /**
7716 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7717 *
7718 * @dev: network device
7719 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7720 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7721 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7722 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7723 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7724 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7725 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7726 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7727 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7728 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7729 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7730 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7731 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7732 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7733 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7734 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7735 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7736 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7737 * case.
7738 * @gfp: allocation flags
7739 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7740 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7741 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7742 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7743 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7744 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7745 *
7746 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7747 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7748 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7749 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7750 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7751 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7752 */
7753 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)7754 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7755 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7756 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7757 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7758 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7759 {
7760 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7761
7762 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params));
7763 params.status = status;
7764 params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
7765 params.links[0].bss = bss;
7766 params.req_ie = req_ie;
7767 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7768 params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7769 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7770 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7771
7772 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp);
7773 }
7774
7775 /**
7776 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7777 *
7778 * @dev: network device
7779 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7780 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7781 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7782 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7783 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7784 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7785 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7786 * the real status code for failures.
7787 * @gfp: allocation flags
7788 *
7789 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7790 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7791 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7792 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7793 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7794 */
7795 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)7796 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7797 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7798 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7799 u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7800 {
7801 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7802 resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7803 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7804 }
7805
7806 /**
7807 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7808 *
7809 * @dev: network device
7810 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7811 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7812 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7813 * @gfp: allocation flags
7814 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7815 *
7816 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7817 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7818 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7819 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7820 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7821 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7822 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7823 */
7824 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)7825 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7826 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7827 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7828 {
7829 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7830 gfp, timeout_reason);
7831 }
7832
7833 /**
7834 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7835 *
7836 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7837 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7838 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7839 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7840 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7841 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
7842 * Otherwise zero.
7843 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
7844 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
7845 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
7846 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
7847 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
7848 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
7849 * %NULL if %links.bss is set.
7850 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
7851 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
7852 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
7853 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
7854 */
7855 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7856 const u8 *req_ie;
7857 size_t req_ie_len;
7858 const u8 *resp_ie;
7859 size_t resp_ie_len;
7860 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7861
7862 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7863 u16 valid_links;
7864 struct {
7865 const u8 *addr;
7866 const u8 *bssid;
7867 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7868 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7869 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7870 };
7871
7872 /**
7873 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7874 *
7875 * @dev: network device
7876 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7877 * @gfp: allocation flags
7878 *
7879 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7880 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7881 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7882 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7883 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7884 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7885 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7886 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7887 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7888 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7889 */
7890 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7891 gfp_t gfp);
7892
7893 /**
7894 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7895 *
7896 * @dev: network device
7897 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
7898 * in case of AP/P2P GO
7899 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
7900 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
7901 * @gfp: allocation flags
7902 *
7903 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7904 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7905 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7906 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7907 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7908 * indicate the 802.11 association.
7909 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
7910 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
7911 * associated STA/GC.
7912 */
7913 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
7914 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
7915
7916 /**
7917 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7918 *
7919 * @dev: network device
7920 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7921 * @ie_len: length of IEs
7922 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7923 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7924 * @gfp: allocation flags
7925 *
7926 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7927 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7928 */
7929 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7930 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7931 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7932
7933 /**
7934 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7935 * @wdev: wireless device
7936 * @cookie: the request cookie
7937 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7938 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7939 * channel
7940 * @gfp: allocation flags
7941 */
7942 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7943 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7944 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7945
7946 /**
7947 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7948 * @wdev: wireless device
7949 * @cookie: the request cookie
7950 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7951 * @gfp: allocation flags
7952 */
7953 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7954 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7955 gfp_t gfp);
7956
7957 /**
7958 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7959 * @wdev: wireless device
7960 * @cookie: the requested cookie
7961 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7962 * @gfp: allocation flags
7963 */
7964 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7965 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7966
7967 /**
7968 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7969 *
7970 * @sinfo: the station information
7971 * @gfp: allocation flags
7972 */
7973 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7974
7975 /**
7976 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7977 * @sinfo: the station information
7978 *
7979 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7980 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7981 * the stack.)
7982 */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)7983 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7984 {
7985 kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7986 }
7987
7988 /**
7989 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7990 *
7991 * @dev: the netdev
7992 * @mac_addr: the station's address
7993 * @sinfo: the station information
7994 * @gfp: allocation flags
7995 */
7996 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7997 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7998
7999 /**
8000 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8001 * @dev: the netdev
8002 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8003 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8004 * @gfp: allocation flags
8005 */
8006 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8007 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8008
8009 /**
8010 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8011 *
8012 * @dev: the netdev
8013 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8014 * @gfp: allocation flags
8015 */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8016 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8017 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8018 {
8019 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8020 }
8021
8022 /**
8023 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8024 *
8025 * @dev: the netdev
8026 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8027 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8028 * @gfp: allocation flags
8029 *
8030 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8031 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8032 * for some reasons, this function is called.
8033 *
8034 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8035 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8036 */
8037 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8038 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8039 gfp_t gfp);
8040
8041 /**
8042 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8043 *
8044 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8045 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8046 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8047 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8048 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on
8049 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8050 * @len: length of the frame data
8051 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8052 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8053 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8054 */
8055 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8056 int freq;
8057 int sig_dbm;
8058 bool have_link_id;
8059 u8 link_id;
8060 const u8 *buf;
8061 size_t len;
8062 u32 flags;
8063 u64 rx_tstamp;
8064 u64 ack_tstamp;
8065 };
8066
8067 /**
8068 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8069 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8070 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8071 *
8072 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8073 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8074 *
8075 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8076 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8077 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8078 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8079 */
8080 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8081 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8082
8083 /**
8084 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8085 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8086 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8087 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8088 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8089 * @len: length of the frame data
8090 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8091 *
8092 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8093 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8094 *
8095 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8096 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8097 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8098 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8099 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8100 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8101 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8102 u32 flags)
8103 {
8104 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8105 .freq = freq,
8106 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8107 .buf = buf,
8108 .len = len,
8109 .flags = flags
8110 };
8111
8112 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8113 }
8114
8115 /**
8116 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8117 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8118 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8119 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8120 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8121 * @len: length of the frame data
8122 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8123 *
8124 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8125 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8126 *
8127 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8128 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8129 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8130 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8131 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8132 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8133 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8134 u32 flags)
8135 {
8136 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8137 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8138 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8139 .buf = buf,
8140 .len = len,
8141 .flags = flags
8142 };
8143
8144 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8145 }
8146
8147 /**
8148 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8149 *
8150 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8151 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8152 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8153 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8154 * @len: length of the frame data
8155 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8156 */
8157 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8158 u64 cookie;
8159 u64 tx_tstamp;
8160 u64 ack_tstamp;
8161 const u8 *buf;
8162 size_t len;
8163 bool ack;
8164 };
8165
8166 /**
8167 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8168 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8169 * @status: TX status data
8170 * @gfp: context flags
8171 *
8172 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8173 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8174 * transmission attempt with extended info.
8175 */
8176 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8177 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8178
8179 /**
8180 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8181 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8182 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8183 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8184 * @len: length of the frame data
8185 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8186 * @gfp: context flags
8187 *
8188 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8189 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8190 * transmission attempt.
8191 */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8192 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8193 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8194 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8195 {
8196 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8197 .cookie = cookie,
8198 .buf = buf,
8199 .len = len,
8200 .ack = ack
8201 };
8202
8203 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8204 }
8205
8206 /**
8207 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8208 * port frames
8209 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8210 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8211 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8212 * @len: length of the frame data
8213 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8214 * @gfp: context flags
8215 *
8216 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8217 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8218 * the transmission attempt.
8219 */
8220 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8221 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8222 gfp_t gfp);
8223
8224 /**
8225 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8226 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8227 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf
8228 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear.
8229 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8230 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that
8231 * skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8232 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8233 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8234 *
8235 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8236 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8237 * control port frames over nl80211.
8238 *
8239 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8240 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8241 *
8242 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8243 */
8244 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8245 bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8246
8247 /**
8248 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8249 * @dev: network device
8250 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8251 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8252 * @gfp: context flags
8253 *
8254 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8255 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8256 */
8257 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8258 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8259 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8260
8261 /**
8262 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8263 * @dev: network device
8264 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8265 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8266 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8267 * threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8268 * @gfp: context flags
8269 */
8270 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8271 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8272
8273 /**
8274 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8275 * @dev: network device
8276 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8277 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8278 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8279 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8280 * @gfp: context flags
8281 *
8282 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8283 * given interval is exceeded.
8284 */
8285 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8286 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8287
8288 /**
8289 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8290 * @dev: network device
8291 * @gfp: context flags
8292 *
8293 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8294 */
8295 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8296
8297 /**
8298 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8299 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8300 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8301 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8302 * @gfp: context flags
8303 *
8304 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8305 */
8306 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8307 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8308 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8309
8310 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8311 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8312 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8313 gfp_t gfp)
8314 {
8315 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8316 }
8317
8318 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8319 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8320 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8321 gfp_t gfp)
8322 {
8323 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8324 }
8325
8326 /**
8327 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8328 * @dev: network device
8329 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8330 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8331 * @gfp: context flags
8332 *
8333 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8334 * frame.
8335 */
8336 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8337 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8338 gfp_t gfp);
8339
8340 /**
8341 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8342 * @netdev: network device
8343 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8344 * @event: type of event
8345 * @gfp: context flags
8346 *
8347 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8348 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8349 * also by full-MAC drivers.
8350 */
8351 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8352 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8353 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
8354
8355 /**
8356 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8357 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8358 *
8359 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8360 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8361 */
8362 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8363
8364 /**
8365 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8366 * @dev: network device
8367 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8368 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8369 * @gfp: allocation flags
8370 */
8371 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8372 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8373
8374 /**
8375 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8376 * @dev: network device
8377 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8378 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8379 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8380 * @gfp: allocation flags
8381 */
8382 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8383 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8384
8385 /**
8386 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8387 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8388 * @addr: the transmitter address
8389 * @gfp: context flags
8390 *
8391 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8392 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8393 * sender.
8394 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8395 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8396 */
8397 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8398 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8399
8400 /**
8401 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8402 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8403 * @addr: the transmitter address
8404 * @gfp: context flags
8405 *
8406 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8407 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8408 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8409 * station to avoid event flooding.
8410 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8411 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8412 */
8413 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8414 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8415
8416 /**
8417 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8418 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8419 * @addr: the address of the peer
8420 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8421 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8422 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8423 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8424 * @gfp: allocation flags
8425 */
8426 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8427 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8428 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8429
8430 /**
8431 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8432 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8433 * @frame: the frame
8434 * @len: length of the frame
8435 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8436 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8437 *
8438 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8439 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8440 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8441 */
8442 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8443 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8444
8445 /**
8446 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8447 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8448 * @frame: the frame
8449 * @len: length of the frame
8450 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8451 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8452 *
8453 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8454 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8455 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8456 */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8457 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8458 const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8459 int freq, int sig_dbm)
8460 {
8461 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8462 sig_dbm);
8463 }
8464
8465 /**
8466 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8467 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8468 * @chandef: the channel definition
8469 * @iftype: interface type
8470 *
8471 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8472 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8473 */
8474 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8475 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8476 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8477
8478 /**
8479 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8480 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8481 * @chandef: the channel definition
8482 * @iftype: interface type
8483 *
8484 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8485 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8486 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8487 * more permissive conditions.
8488 *
8489 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8490 */
8491 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8492 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8493 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
8494
8495 /*
8496 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8497 * @dev: the device which switched channels
8498 * @chandef: the new channel definition
8499 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8500 * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap
8501 *
8502 * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8503 * driver context!
8504 */
8505 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8506 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8507 unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap);
8508
8509 /*
8510 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8511 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
8512 * @chandef: the future channel definition
8513 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8514 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
8515 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
8516 * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap
8517 *
8518 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
8519 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
8520 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
8521 */
8522 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8523 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8524 unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
8525 bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap);
8526
8527 /**
8528 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
8529 *
8530 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
8531 * @band: band pointer to fill
8532 *
8533 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8534 */
8535 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
8536 enum nl80211_band *band);
8537
8538 /**
8539 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
8540 *
8541 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8542 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
8543 *
8544 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
8545 */
8546 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8547 u8 *op_class);
8548
8549 /**
8550 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
8551 *
8552 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
8553 *
8554 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
8555 */
8556 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)8557 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
8558 {
8559 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
8560 }
8561
8562 /*
8563 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
8564 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
8565 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
8566 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
8567 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
8568 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
8569 * @gfp: allocation flags
8570 *
8571 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
8572 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
8573 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
8574 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
8575 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
8576 */
8577 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8578 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
8579 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
8580
8581 /*
8582 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
8583 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
8584 *
8585 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
8586 */
8587 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
8588
8589 /**
8590 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
8591 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
8592 *
8593 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
8594 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
8595 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
8596 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
8597 * is unbound from the driver.
8598 *
8599 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8600 */
8601 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
8602
8603 /**
8604 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
8605 * @dev: the netdev to register
8606 *
8607 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8608 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
8609 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
8610 * instead as well.
8611 *
8612 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8613 */
8614 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
8615
8616 /**
8617 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
8618 * @dev: the netdev to register
8619 *
8620 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
8621 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
8622 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
8623 * usable instead as well.
8624 *
8625 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
8626 */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)8627 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
8628 {
8629 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
8630 }
8631
8632 /**
8633 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
8634 * @ies: FT IEs
8635 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
8636 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
8637 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
8638 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
8639 */
8640 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
8641 const u8 *ies;
8642 size_t ies_len;
8643 const u8 *target_ap;
8644 const u8 *ric_ies;
8645 size_t ric_ies_len;
8646 };
8647
8648 /**
8649 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
8650 * @netdev: network device
8651 * @ft_event: IE information
8652 */
8653 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8654 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
8655
8656 /**
8657 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
8658 * @ies: the input IE buffer
8659 * @len: the input length
8660 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
8661 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
8662 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
8663 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
8664 *
8665 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
8666 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
8667 *
8668 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
8669 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
8670 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
8671 */
8672 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
8673 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
8674 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
8675
8676 /**
8677 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
8678 * @ies: the IE buffer
8679 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8680 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8681 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8682 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8683 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8684 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
8685 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
8686 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8687 *
8688 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8689 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8690 * split.
8691 *
8692 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8693 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8694 *
8695 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8696 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8697 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8698 *
8699 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8700 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8701 * of the buffer should be used.
8702 */
8703 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8704 const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
8705 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
8706 size_t offset);
8707
8708 /**
8709 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
8710 * @ies: the IE buffer
8711 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
8712 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
8713 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
8714 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
8715 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
8716 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
8717 *
8718 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
8719 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
8720 * split.
8721 *
8722 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
8723 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
8724 *
8725 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
8726 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
8727 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
8728 *
8729 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
8730 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
8731 * of the buffer should be used.
8732 */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)8733 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
8734 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
8735 {
8736 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
8737 }
8738
8739 /**
8740 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
8741 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
8742 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
8743 * @gfp: allocation flags
8744 *
8745 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
8746 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
8747 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
8748 * else caused the wakeup.
8749 */
8750 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8751 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
8752 gfp_t gfp);
8753
8754 /**
8755 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
8756 *
8757 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
8758 * @gfp: allocation flags
8759 *
8760 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
8761 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
8762 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
8763 */
8764 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
8765
8766 /**
8767 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
8768 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8769 *
8770 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
8771 */
8772 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8773
8774 /**
8775 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
8776 *
8777 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8778 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8779 *
8780 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
8781 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
8782 * the interface combinations.
8783 */
8784 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8785 struct iface_combination_params *params);
8786
8787 /**
8788 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
8789 *
8790 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8791 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
8792 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
8793 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
8794 *
8795 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
8796 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
8797 * purposes.
8798 */
8799 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8800 struct iface_combination_params *params,
8801 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
8802 void *data),
8803 void *data);
8804
8805 /*
8806 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
8807 *
8808 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8809 * @wdev: wireless device
8810 * @gfp: context flags
8811 *
8812 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
8813 * disconnected.
8814 *
8815 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
8816 */
8817 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8818 gfp_t gfp);
8819
8820 /**
8821 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
8822 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
8823 *
8824 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
8825 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
8826 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
8827 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
8828 *
8829 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
8830 * the driver while the function is running.
8831 */
8832 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8833
8834 /**
8835 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8836 *
8837 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8838 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8839 *
8840 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8841 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8842 */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)8843 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8844 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8845 {
8846 u8 *ft_byte;
8847
8848 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8849 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
8850 }
8851
8852 /**
8853 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
8854 *
8855 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8856 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8857 *
8858 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8859 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8860 */
8861 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)8862 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8863 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8864 {
8865 u8 ft_byte;
8866
8867 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8868 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
8869 }
8870
8871 /**
8872 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
8873 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
8874 *
8875 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
8876 */
8877 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
8878
8879 /**
8880 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
8881 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
8882 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
8883 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
8884 * result.
8885 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
8886 * @inst_id: the local instance id
8887 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
8888 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
8889 * @info_len: the length of the &info
8890 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
8891 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
8892 */
8893 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
8894 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
8895 u8 inst_id;
8896 u8 peer_inst_id;
8897 const u8 *addr;
8898 u8 info_len;
8899 const u8 *info;
8900 u64 cookie;
8901 };
8902
8903 /**
8904 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
8905 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8906 * @match: match notification parameters
8907 * @gfp: allocation flags
8908 *
8909 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
8910 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
8911 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
8912 */
8913 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8914 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
8915
8916 /**
8917 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
8918 *
8919 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8920 * @inst_id: the local instance id
8921 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
8922 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
8923 * @gfp: allocation flags
8924 *
8925 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
8926 */
8927 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8928 u8 inst_id,
8929 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
8930 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
8931
8932 /* ethtool helper */
8933 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
8934
8935 /**
8936 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
8937 * @netdev: network device
8938 * @params: External authentication parameters
8939 * @gfp: allocation flags
8940 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
8941 */
8942 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
8943 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
8944 gfp_t gfp);
8945
8946 /**
8947 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
8948 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8949 * @req: the original measurement request
8950 * @result: the result data
8951 * @gfp: allocation flags
8952 */
8953 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8954 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8955 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
8956 gfp_t gfp);
8957
8958 /**
8959 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
8960 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8961 * @req: the original measurement request
8962 * @gfp: allocation flags
8963 *
8964 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
8965 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
8966 */
8967 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8968 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8969 gfp_t gfp);
8970
8971 /**
8972 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
8973 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8974 * @iftype: interface type
8975 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
8976 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
8977 *
8978 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
8979 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
8980 * check_swif is '1'.
8981 */
8982 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
8983 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
8984
8985
8986 /**
8987 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
8988 * temporarly rejected with a comeback
8989 * @netdev: network device
8990 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the assocation
8991 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
8992 *
8993 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
8994 */
8995 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
8996 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
8997
8998 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
8999
9000 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9001
9002 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \
9003 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9004 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9005 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9006 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \
9007 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9008 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \
9009 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9010 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \
9011 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9012 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \
9013 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9014 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \
9015 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9016 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \
9017 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9018 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \
9019 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9020
9021 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9022 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9023 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9024 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9025
9026 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \
9027 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9028
9029 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9030 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9031
9032 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9033 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg
9034 #else
9035 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9036 ({ \
9037 if (0) \
9038 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \
9039 0; \
9040 })
9041 #endif
9042
9043 /*
9044 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9045 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9046 * file/line information and a backtrace.
9047 */
9048 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \
9049 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9050
9051 /**
9052 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9053 * @netdev: network device
9054 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9055 * @gfp: allocation flags
9056 */
9057 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9058 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9059 gfp_t gfp);
9060
9061 /**
9062 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9063 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9064 */
9065 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9066
9067 /**
9068 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9069 * @dev: network device
9070 * @gfp: allocation flags
9071 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9072 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9073 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9074 */
9075 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp,
9076 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9077 u64 color_bitmap);
9078
9079 /**
9080 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9081 * @dev: network device
9082 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9083 * @gfp: allocation flags
9084 */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,gfp_t gfp)9085 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9086 u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp)
9087 {
9088 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, gfp,
9089 NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9090 0, color_bitmap);
9091 }
9092
9093 /**
9094 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9095 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9096 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9097 *
9098 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9099 */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count)9100 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9101 u8 count)
9102 {
9103 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9104 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9105 count, 0);
9106 }
9107
9108 /**
9109 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9110 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9111 *
9112 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9113 */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev)9114 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9115 {
9116 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9117 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9118 0, 0);
9119 }
9120
9121 /**
9122 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9123 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9124 *
9125 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9126 */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev)9127 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev)
9128 {
9129 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, GFP_KERNEL,
9130 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9131 0, 0);
9132 }
9133
9134 /**
9135 * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap
9136 * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated
9137 * @chandef: channel definition
9138 *
9139 * Validate the puncturing bitmap.
9140 *
9141 * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise.
9142 */
9143 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap,
9144 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9145
9146 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9147